Nortel Networks Network Card Option 11C Mini User Manual

Meridian 1  
Option 11C Mini  
Planning and Installation Guide  
Document Number: 553-3021-209  
Document Release: Standard 3.00  
Date: April 2000  
Year Publish FCC TM  
Copyright © 1999–2000 Nortel Networks  
All Rights Reserved  
Printed in Canada  
Information is subject to change without notice. Nortel Networks reserves the right to make changes in design  
or components as progress in engineering and manufacturing may warrant. This equipment has been tested  
and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules, and the  
radio interference regulations of Industry Canada. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection  
against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment  
generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy, and if not installed and used in accordance with the  
instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a  
residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the  
interference at their own expense.  
SL-1 and Meridian 1 are trademarks of Nortel Networks.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Page 3 of 332  
Revision history  
April 2000  
Issue 3.00, Standard. This is a global document and is up-issued for X11  
Release 25.0x.  
September 1999  
Issue 2.00, Standard. Updated to include Option 11C Mini Phase II content.  
“Appendix A: General information for the United Kingdom” was removed  
from this guide. For UK-specific information, refer to the Meridian 1 Guide  
for the UK (553-3001-110).  
Also, “Appendix B: Additional information for installations in Germany”  
was removed from this guide. Refer to “Chapter 5 — Regulatory  
information” on page 83 for European regulatory information.  
July 1999  
Issue 1.00, Standard.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 4 of 332  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Contents  
About this guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Terminology used in this guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
14  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini . . . 17  
Supported applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
System specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
21  
22  
Asia Pacific, Caribbean and Latin America, and North America . .  
25  
NTDK92 Chassis Expander . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Reserve power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Circuit cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Telephones and Attendant Consoles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Cables and wires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
27  
31  
35  
35  
36  
37  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 6 of 332 Contents  
Differences between Option 11C Mini and Option 11C . . . . . . . . . . .  
41  
Environmental requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
45  
Earthquake bracing requirements for chassis installed on a  
wall in a vertical position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
46  
Conduit requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
54  
Commercial power requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
AC power installation for systems installed on a wall or table . . . .  
55  
55  
Auxiliary equipment power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Modem requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
66  
66  
Maintenance and administration terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Remote access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Meridian Administration Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
67  
67  
68  
Cross-connect terminal requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
68  
General layout guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
69  
Equipment layout plan for installing the chassis on a table . . . . . .  
73  
Card slot assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
77  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information . . . . . . . . . . 83  
System approval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
83  
Notice for United States installations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
83  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice for Canadian installations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
84  
Canadian and United States Network connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
(DID) calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
86  
87  
Radio and TV interference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Information for the United States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
87  
87  
Symbols you must recognize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
Safety instructions when installing telephone equipment . . . . . . . . . . 102  
against earthquakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
Method for earthquake bracing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
Installing the chassis on a wall in a vertical position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116  
Items required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121  
Installing the chassis on a table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Items required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Installing the chassis in a 19 inch rack/cabinet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Items required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 8 of 332 Contents  
Chassis powered by the same service panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139  
Chassis powered by different service panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet . . . . . . 144  
NTAK02 SDI/DCH card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
NTAG26 XMFR card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
NT1R20 Off-Premise Station (OPS) analog line card . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Digital Trunk cards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
Terminal block requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170  
Installing the Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal (Germany) . . . . 172  
Installing the Krone Test Jack Frame for the UK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174  
Connecting the cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178  
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure  
Transfer Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Installing the PFTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
PFTU control lead signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Modem setup requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
Installing and connecting SDI ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199  
Terminal setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201  
Installing and connecting an ethernet cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
Feature set and ISM parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Customer database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Installing software in a new system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
Cross-connecting terminal Digital Subscriber Loops . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Activating telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Activating a default model with a character display . . . . . . . . . . . . 246  
Activating a default model without a character display . . . . . . . . . 248  
Activating a customized model with a character display . . . . . . . . 249  
Activating a customized model without a character display . . . . . . 250  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 10 of 332 Contents  
Connecting trunks with a PFTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254  
CO & DID trunk card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
Central Office trunk card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266  
Trunk connections (UK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
NT5K17 Direct Inward Dial card terminations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card terminations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268  
Alarm through a QUA6 PFTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280  
Passwords and codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
First digits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
Important extension numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288  
Extensions assigned to card slots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289  
Flexible Feature Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
SDI ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trunk routes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293  
Administration telephone models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300  
Central Answering Position (CAP) telephone models . . . . . . . . . . 302  
Analog (500/2500-type) telephone models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303  
General information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315  
Changing the default numbering plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Extensions assigned are different from the default numbering plan 316  
Changing the first number in the numbering plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316  
Conflicts with SDI ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322  
Conflicts with the SPRE code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322  
Conflicts with the attendant extension number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323  
Modifying analog model telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326  
Printing model information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328  
Analog telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328  
Digital telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328  
Removing model telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328  
Creating model trunks and changing route access codes . . . . . . . . . . . 329  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 12 of 332 Contents  
Creating model trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329  
Modifying model trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330  
Removing model trunks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330  
Printing model information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330  
Changing a route access code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16  
Page 13 of 332  
About this guide  
Who should read this guide  
The Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide is for persons  
responsible for planning and installing the Option 11C Mini system.  
Use this guide as a reference tool for Option 11C Mini installations. The  
planning chapters describe the general design, features, limits, and site  
requirements of the Option 11C Mini system. The installation chapters  
provide complete installation instructions for installing a new Option 11C  
Mini system.  
How this guide is organized  
The Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide includes 19 chapters  
and two appendixes. The first part of the guide (Chapters 1 through 5)  
contains information about planning for the installation of your Option 11C  
Mini system. The second part of the guide (Chapters 6 through 19) contains  
procedures for installing your Option 11C Mini system. The appendixes at the  
end of this guide provide information about preprogrammed data.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 14 of 332  
About this guide  
Terminology used in this guide  
The Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide is a global document.  
This guide contains some terms which are not common in the UK. The  
following is a list of these terms and their equivalent in the UK.  
North American term  
UK term or meaning  
analog (500/2500-type) set  
Central Office (CO)  
cross-connect wire  
Direct Inward Dialing (DID)  
E1  
Analog rotary dial/MF4 telephone  
Local Public Exchange  
Jumper wire  
Direct Dialing In (DDI)  
2.0 Mbit, 32 channel digital carrier  
(Megastream)  
Grounding  
Set  
Earthing  
Telephone  
Station  
TIE trunks  
Toll trunks  
T1  
Extension telephone  
Private circuits  
Exchange lines  
1.5 Mbit, 24 channel digital carrier (North  
American equivalent to Megastream)  
WATS, FEX (FX1 and FX2),  
CSA  
Alternative public vendor network services  
(used only in North America)  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About this guide Page 15 of 332  
Related documents  
Refer to the following documents for additional information:  
Option 11C and 11C Mini Upgrade Procedures Guide (553-3021-250)  
Option 11C and 11C Mini Technical Reference Guide (553-3011-100)  
Option 11C and 11C Mini Fault Clearing Guide (553-3011-500)  
Option 11C Central Answering Position Guide (553-3011-320)  
Option 11C Customer Configuration Backup and Control Guide  
(553-3011-330)  
X11 Software Administration Guide (553-3001-311) (International)  
X11 Software Maintenance Guide (553-3001-511) (International)  
X11 Software Administration and Maintenance Guide (553-3001-400)  
(North America)  
X11 Software System Messages Guide (553-3001-411)  
1.5 Mbit DTI / PRI Guide (553-3011-310)  
2.0 Mbit DTI / PRI Guide (553-3011-315)  
ISDN BRI Administration and Maintenance Guide (553-3011-311)  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Description  
(631-4511-100)  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Installation and  
Servicing (631-4511-200)  
Intelligent Peripheral Equipment Circuit Card Supplements  
Meridian Administration Tools User Guides  
Meridian Mail Enhanced Card Option Installation and Maintenance  
Guide (555-7071-210)  
Meridian 1 Set-Based Administration Guide (553-3001-303)  
Meridian 1 Telephone and Attendant Console Installation  
(553-3001-215)  
Meridian 1 European Digital Telephones (553-3001-114)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 16 of 332  
About this guide  
M3900 Series Meridian Digital Telephone Description, Installation, and  
Administration (553-3001-216)  
Meridian 1 Guide for the UK (553-3001-110)  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
26  
Page 17 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C  
Mini  
This chapter provides an overview of the Option 11C Mini system.  
Option 11C Mini system description  
The Option 11C Mini is a small communications system based on existing  
Option 11C technology. The system provides full Meridian 1 feature  
functionality. The Option 11C Mini uses X11 global software which other  
Meridian 1 systems also use.  
In an Option 11C Mini system, the Main Chassis can connect to a Chassis  
Expander. This increases line size to 144 lines. Two copper cables connect  
the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis.  
The Main Chassis and Chassis Expander each provide four Intelligent  
Peripheral Equipment (IPE) card slots. These card slots support line cards,  
trunk cards, and application cards used in other Meridian 1 systems. The  
Option 11C Mini introduces a 48-port Digital Line Card (NTDK16). You  
must insert the 48-port Digital Line Card in a dedicated slot (Slot 4) of the  
Main Chassis. The Main Chassis also provides a dedicated slot (slot 0) for the  
Mini System Controller (MSC) card.  
A processor located on the Mini System Controller (MSC) card in the Main  
Chassis handles call processing, serial ports, and network traffic. Call  
processing on the MSC card is equivalent to that on the Option 11C Small  
System Controller (SSC) card. Use the MSC card for configurations with up  
to 144 lines.  
The power supply for the Option 11C Mini is installed in the chassis before it  
is sent to the customer site. You do not have to install the power supply during  
system installation.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 18 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini  
You can configure the Option 11C Mini as a non-blocking system. You do  
not have to provision the Option 11C Mini for speech paths or time slots.  
The Option 11C Mini provides four chassis installation options. Install the  
Option 11C Mini chassis in the following positions:  
on a wall in a vertical position  
on a wall in a horizontal position  
in a 19 inch rack/cabinet  
on a table  
Figure 1 shows the Option 11C Mini Main Chassis.  
Figure 1  
Option 11C Mini chassis  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini Page 19 of 332  
Installing software and configuring data  
The Option 11C Mini supports a minimum of X11 Release 24.24 software.  
Everything from general business features to advanced applications are  
available. The software contains all of the components related to a release of  
software. These components include software patches, preconfigured  
customer database, feature sets, and other related databases and software.  
When you perform an installation for the first time, use the MSC card for the  
installation. When you upgrade to a new software release, use a Software  
Delivery card (PCMCIA card).  
Flash Drives  
Two Flash Drives, located on the MSC card, perform Meridian software  
operation and customer data storage.  
The first flash device is the Primary Flash Drive. The Primary Flash Drive  
contains Meridian system data and the first copy of customer data required to  
load and run the switch. The Primary Flash Drive is programmed with system  
software before it is shipped to the customer.  
The second Flash Drive is the Backup Flash Drive. The Backup Flash Drive  
stores files that the user can change. Examples of these files are configuration  
data and the second copy of the customer database. If the Primary Flash Drive  
fails, you can retrieve a backup set of customer data. After the backup set of  
customer data is retrieved, you can load it into the system’s active database.  
Software Installation Program  
The Software Installation Program starts during initial installations of the  
Option 11C Mini system. This program is menu driven.The Software  
Installation Program installs the software and puts the Option 11C Mini into  
operation.  
Software Delivery Card  
The Option 11C Mini uses a Software Delivery card (PCMCIA) card to  
upgrade system software and provide storage for a backup copy of customer  
data. The Option 11C Mini uses the same Software Delivery card that the  
Option 11C uses.  
Insert the Software Delivery card in the socket (slot A) located on the  
faceplate of the MSC card. When inserted, you can load software and  
customer databases from the Software Delivery card to the MSC card.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 20 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini  
Security Device  
A Security Device comes with each new Option 11C Mini system. Attach the  
Security Device to the component side of the MSC card at the time of initial  
installation. The Security Device remains on the MSC card for the life of the  
system. The Security Device is used for system identification. This device  
allows the activation of features assigned to the system, through the use of a  
series of keycodes. The system uses keycodes for validation purposes.  
Configuring data  
The Option 11C Mini provides several options for making data configuration  
easier.  
Preprogrammed data  
When you first install an Option 11C Mini system, you must enter customer  
data into the overlay programs. Telephones, for example, must have features  
assigned to their keys, in order for them to function correctly. Data can be  
preprogrammed. If you load preprogrammed data during the installation  
process, the system automatically configures some overlay entries on the  
telephones.  
If the preprogrammed data does not apply to users at one of the sites, you can  
revise the data on-site with a TTY. You can also revise the preprogrammed  
data remotely over a modem connection. You can start with a basic  
configuration. A basic configuration is the least possible amount of data  
required for initial software programming. You must perform this step while  
you are working in the Software Installation Program.  
Model telephones  
You can select many different preprogrammed model telephone layouts.  
Technicians can perform some basic steps at installation to activate multiple  
telephones, using telephone layouts or templates.  
Administration telephones  
If you use default model layouts for telephones and trunk routes, use an  
administrative telephone to make adjustments to items, such as numbering  
plans and access codes. You do not need a TTY input terminal for  
programming the Option 11C Mini unless you require a custom layout.  
You can use the M2616 and M2008 digital telephones for administrative  
functions. The administrative telephone can double as a user’s working  
telephone.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini Page 21 of 332  
Set-Based Administration  
The Set-Based Administration feature makes system installation and  
administration easier. With Set-Based Administration, you can use a  
telephone set to perform several administrative and maintenance procedures.  
Use the Set-Based Administration feature to perform tasks, such as changing  
data for specific features related to sets or changing Calling Party Name  
Display on a set.  
For more information about Set-Based Administration, refer to the  
Meridian 1 Set-Based Administration Guide (553-3001-303).  
Database Archive feature  
The Software Installation program allows the archiving of databases which  
you can use to load a customer site. This feature allows you to configure  
multiple databases in an off-site lab environment. The Database Archive  
feature also allows you to save databases on a Software Delivery (PCMCIA)  
card until the databases are required. You can load the database into the  
system using the Software Delivery card.  
The off-site programming of databases is subject to all security keycode  
restrictions. The off-site system must either use the Security Device that will  
be installed in the Option 11C Mini at the customer site, or must have its own  
keycodes for the feature set.  
Refer to the Option 11C and 11C Mini Upgrade Procedures Guide  
(553-3021-250) for additional information.  
Supported applications  
The Option 11C Mini supports Meridian 1 applications, including the  
following:  
Call Pilot  
Meridian Mail Mini  
Meridian Administration Tools (MAT)  
Meridian Mobility (CT2, CT2+, PCI, and DECT)  
Meridian Integrated RAN (MIRAN)  
Meridian Integrated Conference Bridge (MICB)  
Meridian Home Office  
Meridian Call Center  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 22 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini  
Meridian MAX  
Meridian Link / CCR  
Symposium Call Center  
Symposium Call Center Express  
Symposium Desktop Applications  
Meridian Administration Tools  
The Option 11C Mini interfaces with Meridian Administration Tools (MAT)  
Release 6.5 and later. MAT is an integrated suite of system management  
tools. You can use MAT to configure, control, and manage your Option 11C  
Mini system. MAT operates on a platform that is compatible with a standard  
IBM PC.  
Refer to the MAT User Guides for information about the MAT application, its  
requirements, and how to install it for the Option 11C Mini system.  
Meridian Mail Mini  
The Option 11C Mini supports Meridian Mail Release 12.13 and later.  
Meridian Mail Mini provides up to 12 voice mail ports on an Option 11C  
Mini system. This application supports all optional features and capacity  
expansion.  
The NT6R16AA Meridian Mail double-width card contains four physical  
voice ports. To increase the capacity to a maximum of 12 ports, add up to two  
Digital Signaling Processor (DSP) daughterboards to the card.  
The NT6R16AA card contains a SCSI connector. Use the SCSI connector to  
connect an external tape drive.  
For more information about Meridian Mail Mini, refer to the Meridian Mail  
Enhanced Card Option Installation and Maintenance Guide (555-7071-210).  
System specifications  
Number of card slots  
The NTDK91 Option 11C Mini Main Chassis can hold a maximum of five  
cards. Slot 0 is dedicated to the NTDK97 MSC card; the fourth slot is  
dedicated to the NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card. Program the NTDK16  
in software as slots 4, 5, and 6. Slots 1-3 support existing IPE and CE cards  
(for example, PRI, PRI2, DTI, DTI2, MISP, and SDI/DCH).  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini Page 23 of 332  
The Chassis Expander provides four card slots. The Chassis Expander  
supports Meridian Mail Mini in Slot 10 only. You can place any IPE card in  
slots 7, 8, 9, and 10. The CE-MUX bus extends to slot 10 for Meridian Mail  
only.  
An Option 11C Mini system, including a Main Chassis and a Chassis  
Expander, supports eight physical and ten logical card slots.  
The following is an example of a common Main Chassis configuration:  
one MSC card in slot 0  
one analog line card in slot 1, 2, or 3  
one digital trunk card in slot 1, 2, or 3  
one analog trunk card in slot 1, 2, or 3  
one NTDK16, 48-port Digital Line Card in Slot 4  
The following is an example of a common Chassis Expander configuration:  
A line card in slots 7, 8, and 9  
Meridian Mail Mini in slot 10  
Trunk capacity  
It is difficult to estimate system capacities, as every installation varies  
depending on end-user needs. In a moderate to busy work environment,  
however, a common ratio of users to trunks normally falls between four and  
six users to each trunk.  
Software Generic  
The Option 11C Mini supports X11 Release 24.24 and later software.  
Conference channels  
The MSC card supports 16 conference channels.  
Power supply  
The universal power supply unit is installed inside the chassis before the  
system is sent to the customer. The power supply unit requires no installation  
by the customer. The power supply operates on standard line voltages of  
100-240 VAC. Total output power is 363 Watts.  
Note: The Option 11C Mini system does not support DC power input.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 24 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini  
Backup / reserve power  
You can configure reserve power using an Uninterruptible Power Supply  
(UPS). The Option 11C Mini system does not include the UPS. The  
Option 11C Mini does not support battery backup.  
Power failure transfer occurs when the main power to the Option 11C Mini is  
cut off. When this power interruption occurs, the Power Failure Transfer Unit  
(PFTU) connects pre-determined analog telephones directly to the Central  
Office (CO) trunks. The PFTU is capable of supporting a maximum of five  
or eight telephones, depending on the PFTU used.  
Data backup and restore methods  
The Option 11C Mini provides several methods of backing up  
customer-configured data. These methods are in one of the following  
categories:  
on-site backup  
remote backup over a modem connection  
On-site backup  
You can perform three different types of on-site backup using Overlay 143.  
You can backup customer data from the database in use to one of the  
following:  
Primary Flash Drive  
Backup Flash Drive  
external Software Delivery card (PCMCIA)  
Remote backup  
You can perform remote backup in Overlay 143 by using the Customer  
Configuration Backup and Restore (CCBR) feature. The CCBR feature  
allows you to backup customer-configured data to an external IBM-type PC  
or a Macintosh computer over a modem connection. For more information  
about the remote backup feature, refer to the Customer Configuration Backup  
and Restore Guide (553-3011-330).  
You can perform both the on-site and remote methods of backup during  
normal system operation.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini Page 25 of 332  
Restoring data  
If data becomes corrupt or inoperable, you can restore backup data to the  
main database and Primary Flash Drive from one of the following:  
External PCMCIA Drive  
Backup Flash Drive  
a computer over a modem connection  
Repair facilities  
The following are the addresses for global repair facilities for the Option 11C  
Mini:  
Asia Pacific, Caribbean and Latin America, and North America  
Nortel Networks  
640 Massman Drive  
Nashville, Tennessee  
37210  
USA  
Europe  
Nortel Networks (Ireland) Limited  
Mervue Business Park  
Mervue, Galway  
Ireland  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 26 of 332  
Chapter 1 — Introducing the Option 11C Mini  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44  
Page 27 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C  
Mini equipment  
This chapter describes the main components used to install the Option 11C  
Mini. This chapter also describes the differences between the Option 11C  
Mini and Option 11C systems.  
Main components of the Option 11C Mini  
NTDK91 Main Chassis  
NTDK92 Chassis Expander  
The Main Chassis for the Option 11C Mini system is the NTDK91. The  
NTDK92 is the Chassis Expander. You can connect the Main Chassis to the  
Chassis Expander to increase the line capacity of your system.  
The Main Chassis supports the following:  
NTDK97 Mini System Controller (MSC) installed in Slot 0  
any IPE or CE card in Slots 1, 2, and 3  
a dedicated 48-port Digital Line Card (NTDK16) in Slot 4  
The Chassis Expander supports the following:  
Meridian Mail Mini in Slot 10 only  
With Meridian Mail Mini in Slot 10, you can insert any IPE card in  
Slots 7, 8, and 9.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 28 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Chassis installation options  
You can install the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander in the following  
positions:  
on a wall  
— vertically on a wall  
— horizontally on a wall  
in a rack/cabinet  
on a table  
The following chassis installation kits are available:  
NTTK08AA: for vertical, wall installation  
NTTK09AA: for rack/cabinet installation  
NTTK10AA: for table-top installation  
NTTK11AA: for horizontal, wall installation  
Cable connectors  
25-pair cables connect cards to the cross-connect terminal. Connectors for  
these cables are on the back of the Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander.  
See Figure 2 on page 29.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 29 of 332  
Figure 2  
25-pair cable connectors on the back of the Main Chassis  
25-pair  
connectors  
The Auxiliary (AUX), Serial Data Interface (SDI), and Ethernet connectors  
are on the back left-hand side of the Main Chassis. See Figure 3.  
The AUX port connects auxiliary equipment, such as a Power Failure  
Transfer Unit (PFTU), to the Option 11C Mini. The SDI connector in the  
Main Chassis interfaces three SDI ports using a three-port SDI cable. The  
Ethernet connector in the Main Chassis provides a 10 Mbit Ethernet port. The  
Ethernet port accepts an industry-standard Medium Access Unit (MAU).  
Insert the Ethernet cable into this MAU.  
The back of the Main Chassis also contains connectors for connecting the  
Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander. These connectors are for the  
DS-30X and CE-MUX connections. See Figure 3.  
The power connector is at the back of the chassis on the upper left-hand side.  
See Figure 3. Secure the power cord with a cable tie.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 30 of 332  
Figure 3  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Connectors on the back of the Main Chassis  
Power cord  
connector  
SDI  
connector  
CE-MUX  
connector  
DS-30X  
connector  
Ethernet  
connector  
Auxiliary  
connector  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 31 of 332  
Figure 4 shows the connectors on the back of the Chassis Expander.  
Figure 4  
Connectors on the back of the Chassis Expander  
Power cord  
connector  
DS-30X  
connector  
CE-MUX  
connector  
25-pair  
connectors  
Cooling  
The NTDK91 Main Chassis and the NTDK92 Chassis Expander have forced  
air cooling. As a result, you can install the chassis in a horizontal or vertical  
position. The fan inside the chassis is controlled by heat. It runs at a reduced  
speed at room temperature.  
CAUTION  
Do not block chassis ventilation.  
Power supply  
The Option 11C Mini universal power supply uses AC input. The power  
supply is factory installed in the chassis. The power supply is not customer  
replaceable. The Option 11C Mini system does not support DC input.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 32 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Power switch  
There is a power switch on the front of the NTDK91 Main Chassis and the  
NTDK92 Chassis Expander. Use this switch to turn the Option 11C Mini  
power on and off. See Figure 5 on page 34.  
Power status indicator  
There is a power status indicator (LED) on the front cover (top left-hand  
corner) of the Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander. When the LED is  
green, the power is in operation. When the LED is off, there is a power failure  
Power supply DIP switch settings  
waiting voltages. See Table 2 and Figure 5 on page 34 for all DIP switch  
setting options. Typical settings are shown for the following regions:  
“Asia Pacific/Cala power supply DIP switch settings” on page 33  
“Europe power supply DIP switch settings” on page 33  
“North American power supply DIP switch settings” on page 34  
Table 1  
Power supply DIP switch settings  
Ringing Frequency (Hz)  
Ringing Amplitude (Vrms)  
Message Waiting Lamp (VDC)  
20  
25  
50  
70  
75  
80  
86  
-120  
-150  
Disable  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
1
2
ON  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
3
4
5
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
6
7
8
NOT USED  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
X
OFF  
ON  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 33 of 332  
Table 2  
Asia Pacific/Cala power supply DIP switch settings  
In the Asia Pacific/Cala region, usage of the high voltage Message Waiting  
Lamp is optional. The following table shows the settings for 25Hz, 75V and  
-150V for the Message Waiting Lamp.  
Ringing Frequency (Hz)  
Ringing Amplitude (Vrms)  
Message Waiting Lamp (VDC)  
20  
25  
50  
70  
75  
80  
86  
-120  
-150  
Disable  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
1
2
OFF  
ON  
3
4
5
ON  
6
7
8
NOT USED  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Table 3  
Europe power supply DIP switch settings  
In Europe, usage of the high voltage Message Waiting Lamp is not allowed.  
The following table shows the settings for 25Hz, 75V and the Message  
Waiting Lamp is Disabled.  
Ringing Frequency (Hz)  
Ringing Amplitude (Vrms)  
Message Waiting Lamp (VDC)  
20  
25  
50  
70  
75  
80  
86  
-120  
-150  
Disable  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
1
2
OFF  
ON  
3
4
5
ON  
6
7
8
NOT USED  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 34 of 332  
Table 4  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
North American power supply DIP switch settings  
In North America, usage of the high voltage Message Waiting Lamp is  
optional and requires -150V when enabled. The following table shows the  
settings for 20Hz, 86V and the Message Waiting Lamp is disabled.  
Ringing Frequency (Hz)  
Ringing Amplitude (Vrms)  
Message Waiting Lamp (VDC)  
20  
25  
50  
70  
75  
80  
86  
-120  
-150  
Disable  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
Switch  
Setting  
1
2
ON  
ON  
3
4
5
ON  
ON  
ON  
6
7
8
NOT USED  
ON  
ON  
Note: Set the dip switches before the system powers up.  
Figure 5 shows the power switch, power status indicator, and DIP switch  
settings.  
Figure 5  
Front of chassis  
Power status  
indicator  
Power  
switch  
DIP switch  
settings  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 35 of 332  
Reserve power supply  
You can use an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) to provide a backup  
power supply for the NTDK91 and the NTDK92 chassis. A UPS provides a  
continuous AC power supply. Install the UPS unit according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions. Refer to “Power consumption worksheets for the  
Option 11C Mini system” on page 64. This section contains worksheets to  
help you determine the power draw for the UPS.  
Circuit cards  
The Option 11C Mini introduces the NTDK97 Mini System Controller  
(MSC) card and the NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card. This section  
provides a short overview of these two cards. For more information about  
these cards and the other circuit cards supported on the Option 11C Mini,  
refer to “Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards” on page 147.  
NTDK97 Mini System Controller card  
The NTDK97 Mini System Controller (MSC) card is based on the  
Option 11C NTDK20 Small System Controller (SSC) card. The MSC card  
includes a Central Processing Unit (CPU) which handles call processing for  
the system. The MSC card also includes an Ethernet controller, storage for  
system and customer data, and system memory.  
The MSC card stores system and customer data. This card is programmed  
with system software before it is shipped to the customer. Additional memory  
on the MSC card temporarily stores and processes automated routines and  
user-programmed commands. The MSC card also keeps a copy of customer  
files in the event of data loss on the Backup Flash Drive.  
You must install the MSC card in Slot 0 of the Main Chassis.  
Security Device  
The MSC card is equipped with a socket. This socket holds the Security  
Device. Each new Option 11C Mini system comes with a Security Device.  
You must attach the Security Device to the MSC card during initial  
installation.  
PCMCIA interface  
The NTDK97 MSC card has a 2-slot PCMCIA interface socket located on its  
faceplate. You can insert a Software Delivery card into the socket. Use the  
Software Delivery card for software upgrades on an existing Option 11C  
Mini system. You can also use this socket for creating an external backup  
copy of the customer database.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 36 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card  
The NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card provides an interface to a maximum  
of 48 digital integrated voice and 48 data ports. The NTDK16 Digital Line  
Card is functionally equivalent to three NT8D02 Digital Line Cards.  
Note 1: Only place the NTDK16 Digital Line Card in slot 4 of the Main  
Chassis.  
Note 2: The NTDK16 Digital Line Card is not required for the  
Option 11C Mini system to operate.  
Telephones and Attendant Consoles  
The following is a list of the telephones and Attendant Consoles supported by  
the Option 11C Mini:  
Analog (500/2500 type) telephones, with or without message waiting  
lamps  
Meridian Digital Telephones (M2006, M2008, M2009, M2018, M2112,  
M2216, M2616, and M3000)  
Meridian Digital Telephones (M3110, M3310, and M3820)  
Note: The M3110, M3310, and M3820 Meridian Digital Telephones are  
available in Europe only.  
Meridian Digital Telephones (M3901, M3902, M3903, M3904, and  
M3905)  
Note: Only the M3901 and the M3905 Meridian Digital Telephones are  
supported in Europe.  
M2616 or M2216 Central Answering Position (CAP). These telephones  
must have an ACD LCD display installed to function as a CAP  
telephone.  
Meridian 2250 (TCM) Attendant Consoles  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 37 of 332  
Cables and wires  
Table 5 lists the Option 11C Mini cable kits and their contents.  
Table 5  
Option 11C Mini cable kits  
Cable or wire  
Purpose/description  
NTDK88 Main cable kit  
NTBK48 three-port SDI cable The NTBK48 connects equipment, such as  
TTYs and modems to the Option 11C Mini.  
Use the NTBK48 with the NTDK97 MSC  
card.  
NTAK1104 AUX cable  
The NTAK1104 connects a PFTU to a  
system chassis.  
A0601396 F-M DCE to DTE  
converter  
You can use the A0601396 when  
connecting SDI ports to equipment, such  
as TTYs and modems.  
A0601397 F-F DCE to DTE  
converter  
You can use the A0501397 when  
connecting SDI ports to equipment such  
as TTYs and modems.  
A037683  
Ferrite filter  
NTDK89 Chassis Expander cable kit  
NTDK95 CE-MUX/DS-30X bus The NTDK95 connects the Main Chassis  
cable  
to the Chassis Expander. You need two of  
these cables to connect the Main Chassis  
and the Chassis Expander.  
Length: 2 ft (610 mm)  
NTTK15 cable kit for Australia/New Zealand  
A0386023 power cord for  
Australia and New Zealand  
The A0386023 connects a system chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 8 ft (2438 mm)  
A0376837  
Ferrite filter  
NTTK22 cable kit for Denmark  
A0386026 power cord for  
Denmark  
The A0386026 connects a system chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 8 ft (2438 mm)  
A0376837  
Ferrite filter  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 38 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Table 5  
Option 11C Mini cable kits (Continued)  
Cable or wire  
Purpose/description  
NTTK16 cable kit for Europe  
A0381307 power cord for  
Europe  
The A0381307 connects a system chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 8 ft (2438 mm)  
A0376837  
Ferrite filter  
NTTK14 cable kit for North America  
A0317094 power cord  
The A0317094 connects a system chassis  
to a 110 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 9 ft 10 in. (3000 mm)  
NTTK17 cable kit for Switzerland  
A0386024 power cord for  
Switzerland  
The A0386024 connects a system chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 8 ft (2438 mm)  
A0376837  
Ferrite filter  
NTTK18 cable kit for the UK  
A0381306 power cord for the  
UK  
The A0381306 connects a system chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power source.  
Length: 8 ft (2438 mm)  
Table 6 lists miscellaneous cables and wires used with the Option 11C Mini.  
Table 6  
Option 11C Mini miscellaneous cables and wires  
Cable and wire  
Purpose / description  
A0379411 power cord  
(International)  
The A0379411 connects the chassis  
to a 220 V AC commercial power  
source  
Length: 8 ft. 2 in. (2492 mm)  
NE-A25B 25-pair cable  
NTAK19FA/FB cable  
The NE-A25B connects Peripheral  
Equipment cards to the cross-connect  
terminal. NE-A25B connectors are on  
the back of each chassis.  
The NTAK19FA/FB is a four-port SDI  
cable used with the NTAK02 circuit  
card (see Note 1).  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 39 of 332  
Table 6  
Option 11C Mini miscellaneous cables and wires (Continued)  
Cable and wire  
Purpose / description  
NTAK19EC cable  
The NTAK19EC is a two-port SDI  
cable used with the NTAK03 circuit  
card.  
NTAK1108/1118 9-to-25 pin  
RS232 converter cable  
The NTAK1108/1118 connects SDI  
ports and terminals (see Note 1).  
A0378652 F-F DCE to DTE  
converter, or A0381016 F-M  
DCE to DTE converter  
The A0378652 connects SDI ports to  
equipment, such as TTYs and  
modems.  
NTBK04 1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI  
carrier cable (A0394216)  
The NTBK04 connects the NTAK09  
1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI card to the Channel  
Service Unit (CSU). The NTBK04  
carries Tx and Rx pairs to a standard  
5-pin connector.  
NTBK05AA/DA 2.0 Mbit  
The NTBK05AA/DA carries Tx and Rx  
DTI/PRI carrier cable A0394217 pairs to a standard 120-Ohm  
D-connector (see Note 1).  
NT8D7205  
DTI/PRI carrier cable  
NTBK05CA coaxial cable  
NTBK05DA twisted pair cable  
NTAK10 2.0 Mbit DTI cable  
NTAK79 2.0 Mbit PRI cable  
NTAK50 2.0 Mbit PRI cable  
These cables provide DTI/PRI  
connections. The cables carry Tx and  
Rx pairs to a standard 5-pin connector  
(see Note 2).  
25-pair inside wiring cables  
equipped with amphenol-type  
connectors  
25-pair inside wiring cables extend the  
Peripheral Equipment connections  
from the system chassis to the  
cross-connect terminal, and connect  
PFTUs.  
#6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire  
Gauge) insulated ground wire  
The #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge)  
connects a system chassis to a  
building ground source.  
2
2
10 mm (#6 AWG) insulated  
The 10 mm (#6 AWG) insulated  
ground wire (UK)  
ground wire connects a system  
chassis to a building ground source.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 40 of 332  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Table 6  
Option 11C Mini miscellaneous cables and wires (Continued)  
Cable and wire  
Purpose / description  
2
2
#6 AWG (20 mm ) insulated  
ground wire (Europe)  
The #6 AWG (20 mm ) insulated  
ground wire connects a chassis to a  
building ground source.  
2
2
#8 AWG (10 mm ) insulated  
The #8 AWG (10 mm ) connects a  
ground wire (Germany)  
chassis to a building ground source.  
Cross-connect wire  
The cross-connect wire makes cross  
connections at the cross-connect  
terminal.  
This cable is available in different versions, depending on local EMC  
Note 1:  
specifications.  
These cables are not supported under EMC specifications VL43.140P.  
Note 2:  
Miscellaneous items for installation  
The following is a list of miscellaneous items that you can use as part of  
Option 11C Mini system installation. Quantities needed depend on the site  
and customer requirements:  
QUA6 Power Failure Transfer Units (PFTU) to transfer lines during a  
power or system failure  
NTBK80 grounding block  
modems or Data Communication Equipment (DCE) for remote access to  
the system  
on-site Data Terminating Equipment (DTE) or TTY terminal for  
accessing the system  
connecting blocks for the cross-connect terminal  
transformers and centralized power supplies for items such as digit  
displays on telephones  
optional equipment such as music sources, RAN machines, paging  
equipment, and CDR devices  
NTAK92 Off-Premise Protection Module for connecting up to four  
off-premise analog telephones  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 41 of 332  
additional Modem Eliminator (NULL Modem without hardware  
handshaking). The A0601397 converter may be required to interface the  
DTE to the system.  
industry-standard Ethernet Medium Access Unit (MAU)  
Differences between Option 11C Mini and Option 11C  
Refer to Table 7 for a comparison of the Option 11C Mini and Option 11C  
systems.  
Table 7  
Comparison of Option 11C Mini and Option 11C  
Item  
Option 11C Mini  
Option 11C  
Physical packaging Main Chassis NTDK91  
Chassis Expander NTDK92  
Main cabinet NTAK11  
Two copper cables connect the  
Main Chassis to the Chassis  
Expander.  
Fiber-optic cable connects the  
Main Cabinet to the Expansion  
Cabinet (upgraded systems may  
still have copper cable  
connection).  
Capacity  
Main Chassis:  
Main Cabinet:  
4 physical slots  
logical slots (slots 1-6)  
10 physical slots  
(slots 1-10)  
Expansion Cabinet  
Up to 4 additional NTAK11  
Chassis Expander  
4 physical slots  
slots (slots 7-10)  
cabinets can be connected  
with fiber-optic cable  
(slots 20-50)  
Supports up to 144 lines  
Chassis installation Four chassis installation options:  
Supports up to 700 lines  
Two chassis installation options:  
vertically on a wall  
horizontally on a wall  
rack/cabinet  
wall  
floor  
table  
Cooling  
Forced air, thermally controlled  
cooling  
convection cooling  
(Fan installed inside chassis)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 42 of 332  
Table 7  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Comparison of Option 11C Mini and Option 11C (Continued)  
Item  
Option 11C Mini  
Option 11C  
Power  
AC power only  
AC or DC power  
universal power supply  
factory installed in chassis  
NTDK78/NTDK75/  
NTAK04/NTAK05  
not field replaceable  
field replaceable  
power switch on chassis  
Reserve power  
Cables  
UPS only  
UPS and battery backup  
New NTDK95 cable introduced  
(Two NTDK95 cables connect the  
Main Chassis to the Chassis  
Expander)  
Auxiliary cable used only for  
PFTU.  
Auxiliary cable used for PFTU or to  
provide power for Attendant  
Console.  
Ethernet  
standard 15-pin AUI on  
chassis  
NTDK27 ethernet adapter  
cable required  
NTDK27 ethernet adapter  
cable not required  
May need to set J7 jumper  
no jumper settings  
required  
CPU  
NTDK97 Mini System Controller  
(MSC)  
NTDK20 Small System Controller  
(SSC)  
PCMCIA interface  
3 SDI ports  
PCMCIA interface  
3 SDI ports  
30 channels TDS  
8 units DTR or XTD  
30 channels TDS  
8 units DTR or XTD  
4 units of MFC,  
4 units of MFC,  
MFE/MFK5/MFK6/MFR or  
8 DTR/XTD units  
MFE/MFK5/MFK6/MFR or  
8 DTR/XTD units  
Maximum 16 conference  
channels  
32 channels on SSC  
16 channels per fiber-optic  
daughterboard  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment Page 43 of 332  
Table 7  
Comparison of Option 11C Mini and Option 11C (Continued)  
Item  
Option 11C Mini  
Option 11C  
C: drive on NTDK97 is 16  
Mbytes  
C: drive on  
NTDK21/NTDK81 is 8  
Mbytes  
Z: drive on NTDK97 is 1.5  
Mbytes  
Z: drive on NTDK20 is 1.5  
Mbytes  
NTDK97 program store is  
32 Mbytes  
NTDK21 program store is  
24 Mbytes  
DRAM on NTDK97 is 16  
Mbytes  
NTDK81 program store is  
32 Mbytes  
DRAM - 8 or 16 Mbytes  
SIMM  
Daughterboards  
None  
NTDK21/NTDK81  
Software Daughterboard  
NTDK22, NTDK24,  
NTDK79, NTDK84, and  
NTDK85, Fiber-optic  
Expansion Daughterboards  
Software  
X11 Release 24.24 and later  
X11 Release 22 and later  
Software  
Installation  
Software is preprogrammed on  
MSC card.  
Software is preprogrammed on  
Software Daughterboard.  
Option 11C Mini uses the same  
feature sets, ISM parameters, and  
keycode format as the Option 11C.  
Software upgrades  
IPE and CE cards  
Perform software upgrades using  
the same PCMCIA card as the  
Option 11C.  
Perform Software upgrades using  
a PCMCIA card.  
The Option 11C Mini supports the  
same IPE and CE cards as the  
Option 11C  
The supported CE cards are: PRI,  
DTI, PRI2, DTI2, SDI/DCH,  
TDS/DTR, MISP  
Only slots 1-3 in the Main Chassis  
support CE cards.  
Only slots 1-9 in the Main Cabinet  
support CE cards.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 44 of 332  
Table 7  
Chapter 2 — Identifying the Option 11C Mini equipment  
Comparison of Option 11C Mini and Option 11C (Continued)  
Item  
Option 11C Mini  
Option 11C  
48-port Digital Line  
Card  
Only the Option 11C Mini system  
supports the NTDK16 48-port  
DLC.  
NTDK16 not supported  
only install this card in slot  
4 of the Main Chassis  
configured as slots 4, 5,  
and 6  
The NTDK16 Digital Line Card  
Note:  
is not required for the Option 11C Mini  
system to operate.  
Meridian Mail  
Only slot 10 in the Chassis  
Expander supports Meridian Mail  
Mini.  
Slot 10 in the Main Cabinet  
supports Meridian Mail Card  
Option and Meridian Mail  
Enhanced Card Option.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
68  
Page 45 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site  
requirements  
Before you install the Option 11C Mini system, make sure that the site meets  
all environmental, grounding, power, and cross-connect terminal  
requirements.  
Environmental requirements  
The environment in which the Meridian 1 Option 11C Mini system operates  
must meet the following general conditions:  
Make sure that the room is clean and well ventilated. Each chassis can  
dissipate up to 370 Watts of power. There must be enough ventilation in  
the equipment room to maintain the temperature at an acceptable level.  
For installed chassis, maintain the temperature between 0° and 45° C  
(32° and 113° F).  
Maintain the humidity between 5% and 95% non-condensing.  
Select a location for installing the equipment that is not subject to  
constant vibration.  
Locate the equipment at least 12 ft (3660 mm) away from sources of  
electrostatic, electromagnetic, or radio frequency interference. These  
sources can include:  
— power tools  
— appliances (such as vacuum cleaners)  
— office business machines (such as copying machines)  
— all electric motors  
— electrical transformers  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 46 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Earthquake bracing requirements for chassis installed on a  
wall in a vertical position  
IMPORTANT  
The following earthquake bracing guidelines meet the requirements  
for the state of California specifications in the United States. Other  
areas or countries can have different requirements.  
CAUTION  
For earthquake bracing, you must install the Option 11C Mini chassis  
on a wall in a vertical position.  
Note: The earthquake bracing method for the Option 11C Mini does not  
guarantee that the system will continue to operate during or after an  
earthquake.  
To earthquake brace your system, use a piece of 3/4 in. (20 mm) plywood as  
a backboard. Fasten the plywood to the wall with a minimum of six fasteners.  
(Refer to Table 9 on page 47 for a description of the appropriate fasteners.)  
Fasten the chassis to the backboard.  
Table 8 identifies the maximum acceptable wall height for different types of  
stud wall construction in areas prone to earthquakes.  
Table 8  
Minimum wall requirements – stud construction  
Spacing off  
center  
Maximum Height of  
Wall  
Wall Studs  
2 in. x 4 in. wooden studs  
2 in. x 6 in. wooden studs  
3 5/8 in. 20 gauge metal studs  
3 5/8 in. 18 gauge metal studs  
16 in. or 24 in.  
16 in. or 24 in.  
16 in. or 24 in.  
16 in. or 24 in.  
10 ft  
16 ft  
12 ft  
16 ft  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 47 of 332  
Table 9  
Minimum fastener requirements  
Type of wall  
Fasteners  
Wooden studs  
#10 wood screws  
Embedded a minimum of 1  
in. in wood studs  
Metal studs  
# 14 sheet metal  
screws  
Embedded a minimum of 1  
in. in metal studs  
Concrete  
(2000 PSI)  
1/4 in. HILTI KB-II  
Embedded a minimum of  
1 1/8 in.  
Masonry  
Redhead Dynabolt  
sleeve anchor  
Fasten the mounting bracket for each chassis to the piece of plywood with the  
five, 1 in. #14 screws supplied with the bracket.  
“Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes” on  
page 105 of this guide contains a detailed procedure for earthquake bracing.  
Grounding requirements  
WARNING  
Failure to follow grounding recommendations can result in a system  
installation that is:  
• unsafe for personnel working on, or using the equipment  
• not protected correctly from lightning or power transients  
• subject to service interruptions  
Before you install an Option 11C Mini and before you apply AC power,  
measure the impedance of the building ground reference. An ECOS 1023  
POW-R-MATE, or another meter like the POW-R-MATE, is acceptable for  
this purpose. If the ground path connected to the Option 11C Mini has an  
impedance of 5 Ohms or more, make better grounding arrangements. Make  
any improvements to the grounding system before you install the Option 11C  
Mini.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 48 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
The following are additional grounding requirements:  
CAUTION  
Never connect the single point ground conductor from the Option 11C  
Mini system to structural steel members or electrical conduit. Never  
tie this conductor to a ground source or grounded electrode that is not  
hard-wired to the building reference conductor.  
Ground conductors for the Option 11C Mini system:  
— must not be smaller than #6 AWG (#40 metric) at any point (see  
Table 10 on page 49. This table provides a list of grounding wire  
requirements specific to some areas)  
— must be routed through the same conduit as the phase conductors  
that serve the system  
— must not be smaller than any phase conductor in the same conduit  
— do not carry current under normal operating conditions  
All ground conductors in the building:  
— must be isolated from the neutral bus except at the service entrance  
to the building  
— must be hardwired to the main ground reference  
Avoid spliced conductors. Continuous conductors have lower  
impedance, and they are more reliable than spliced conductors.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 49 of 332  
All conductors must terminate in a permanent way. Make sure all  
terminations are easily visible and available for maintenance purposes.  
Tag ground connections with a clear message such as “CRITICAL  
CONNECTION: DO NOT REMOVE OR DISCONNECT”.  
Table 10  
Area-specific grounding wire requirements  
Area  
Grounding wire requirements  
2
Germany  
#8 AWG (10 mm ) green/yellow wire  
2
Other areas in Europe  
not smaller than #6 AWG (16 mm ) at any  
point  
UK  
two green/yellow wires no thinner than two  
10 mm  
2
CAUTION  
For an installed Option 11C Mini, the impedance of the link between  
the ground post of the Main Chassis and the single point ground to  
which it connects must be less than 0.25 Ohms.  
CAUTION  
Transients in supply conductors and ground systems can damage  
integrated circuits. This damage can result in unreliable Option 11C  
Mini operation. Damage caused by transients is not always  
immediately apparent. Degradation can occur over a period of time.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 50 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Ground bus isolation (Canada and the United States)  
According to the exception to article 384-20 in the United States National  
Electrical Code (NEC), a panel’s ground bus can be isolated from the  
housing. This exception applies provided that the panel is not at the main  
service entrance. This exception applies to some Canadian locations also. For  
more information about ground bus isolation, refer to local electrical codes.  
CAUTION  
Do not isolate the ground bus from the housing unless permitted by  
local electrical codes. Do not perform work inside electrical panels  
unless you are a qualified electrician. Do not try to remove bonding  
conductors without approval from qualified personnel.  
CAUTION  
Route ground conductors, between supply panels, through the same  
conduit as the supply conductors. This safety requirement is part of  
both the National Electrical Code (NEC) and the Canadian Electrical  
Code (CEC).  
Single Point Grounding (SPG)  
Correct grounding of communications systems is necessary for protecting  
equipment from the hazards of surge and noise interference. The Single Point  
Grounding (SPG) method of protecting communications equipment is the  
Nortel Networks standard for Meridian 1 systems.  
The requirements for Single Point Grounding are in the following major  
categories: Safety, Protection, EMC, Installation and Maintenance,  
Powering, and Advances in Technology.  
Safety  
For a safe working environment, your grounding system must be able to  
dissipate unwanted surge energies, such as lighting on the outside plant. The  
grounding system must be designed so that fuse or breakers operate to disrupt  
the excessive current flow caused by a power fault.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 51 of 332  
Protection  
Correct grounding is a necessary component of the protection system for  
equipment. This grounding includes grounding for outside plant cable shields  
and protectors, and the grounds for framework, battery, and logic references.  
EMC  
To make sure that there is good emission and susceptibility performance of  
the equipment, you must consider the Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC)  
grounding requirements.  
Installation and Maintenance  
A grounding system is cost effective to install and maintain when it is part of  
the initial electrical installation for the customer’s premises. If you try to  
correct violations of national codes after the initial installation, it is both  
difficult and costly.  
Powering  
The grounding system must consider the power options for the equipment.  
The grounding system must consider if the equipment is backed up with an  
Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS). Consider the grounding and powering  
of all equipment that is part of the telecommunications system as one large  
system. Perform the installation taking this information into consideration.  
Advances in Technology  
The component density on circuit cards continues to increase because of the  
miniaturization and multi-layering of printed circuit boards. The operating  
speeds of the integrated circuits are ever increasing. Grounding provides  
protection for these components, and is very important.  
The SPG of a system is the point at which telecommunications equipment  
bonds to the ground. A copper busbar normally acts as the system SPG.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 52 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
You can use any of the following busbars as a system SPG:  
building principal ground, normally in building with one floor  
floor ground bar, normally in buildings with more than one floor  
dedicated SPG bar bonded to the building grounding system  
a section of the battery return bar of the power plant  
You can configure subsystems of a telecommunications system, such as  
groups of frames or equipment, as separate single point ground entities  
connected in a star configuration to the system SPG.  
Figure 6  
Single point grounding  
Various Communication Subsystems  
SPG  
553-9479  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 53 of 332  
Grounding method  
CAUTION  
To prevent ground loops, power all chassis from the same dedicated  
power panel. Ground all Main Chassis to the power panel through the  
grounding block. Ground the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis.  
The method of grounding used for the Option 11C Mini depends on whether  
the same service panel powers all chassis.  
The following three grounding scenarios are possible:  
1
2
3
A system with one chassis  
A system with more than one chassis, powered by the same service panel  
A system with more than one chassis, powered by different service  
A system with one chassis or multiple chassis powered by one  
service panel  
For each Main Chassis, connect a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) ground  
wire from the chassis to the NTBK80 grounding block. See Table 10 on  
page 49 for grounding wire requirements specific to some areas. Connect the  
grounding block to a ground source (the ground bus in the AC power service  
panel).  
Consider the Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander as the same ground.  
Jumper the ground wire from the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis and  
then back to the grounding block.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 54 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Chassis powered by different service panels  
For each Main Chassis, connect a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) ground  
wire from the chassis to the NTBK80 grounding block. See Table 10 on  
page 49 for grounding wire requirements specific to some areas. If any  
chassis cannot be powered from the same service panel, ground it separately  
from the other chassis back to the service panel that supplies it. Power each  
Main Chassis and Chassis Expander pair from the same service panel.  
Note 3: If a chassis requires a separate ground, ground it using the same  
method that you use for a system with one chassis.  
Note 4: In the UK, you can connect the grounding wire from the chassis  
to an NTBK80 grounding block or through a Krone Test Jack Frame.  
Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet  
You must ground each piece of equipment in a rack/cabinet. If a piece of  
equipment does not have a ground lug, then ground the whole rack/cabinet.  
Conduit requirements  
Conductive conduit linking panels and equipment are legal for use as a  
grounding network in most countries. For all system ground paths for the  
Option 11C Mini, use the correct size of insulated copper conductors routed  
inside conduit when possible. A ground link that depends on conduit can  
defeat the improvements made by installing dedicated panels and  
transformers. The following are the reasons why:  
Personnel who service different equipment can separate conduit links. If  
this separation occurs between the Option 11C Mini system and the  
building ground reference, the conduit cannot provide a ground path.  
This situation is a hazardous.  
Metal conduit often corrodes, especially at threaded connections.  
Corrosion increases resistance. This problem becomes worse when  
multiple links are involved. If you apply paint over the conduit, it is  
possible that the corrosion process will occur more quickly.  
Always fasten conduit to secure surfaces. Often, conduit is bolted to  
structural steel members, which can function as ground conductors to  
noisy equipment (for example, compressors and motors). The coupling  
of these noisy signals into the Option 11C Mini grounding system can  
damage its performance. The resulting intermittent malfunctions can be  
difficult to trace.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 55 of 332  
Commercial power requirements  
The Option 11C Mini system is available with AC-power only.  
The optimal installation of the AC-powered Option 11C Mini system  
includes a direct connection to the electrical system in the building, provided  
some requirements are met. Refer to AC-powered installation later in this  
You can use an approved isolation transformer for AC-powered systems  
when meeting the optimum requirements is not possible or is too expensive.  
See “Alternative AC-powered installation” on page 58.  
Refer to “Power consumption worksheets for the Option 11C Mini system”  
on page 64 to determine the power consumption of the Option 11C Mini.  
AC power installation for systems installed on a wall or table  
Use a dedicated AC service panel with the Option 11C Mini system. Do not  
connect equipment that is not related to the Option 11C Mini to this panel.  
Keep all lighting, fans, motors, air conditioning equipment, and the like, as  
“electrically separate” from the Option 11C Mini system as possible. The  
Main Chassis and Chassis Expander can share the same AC breaker.  
AC power installation for systems installed in a rack/cabinet  
If other data communications equipment is in the same rack/cabinet as the  
Option 11C Mini, power each piece of equipment from an isolated ground  
outlet. The same service panel must service all outlets.  
Power from each outlet must meet the input requirements of at least one  
Option 11C Mini power supply, as listed in Tables 11 through 13. Check  
power requirements for other system equipment. Install additional outlets if  
you need to.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 56 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Table 11  
AC input requirements for each NTDK91 and NTDK92 (North America)  
Recommended: 100-120 volts  
Voltage  
Maximum limits: 90 and 132 volts  
Single phase  
50-60 Hz  
Frequency  
550 VA maximum  
Power  
(I/P max)  
120 volt, 15 Amp supply  
Outlet Type  
Table 12  
AC input requirements for each NTDK91 and NTDK92 (Europe and UK)  
Recommended: 208/220 volts  
Maximum limits: 180 and 250 volts  
Single phase  
Voltage  
50-60 Hz  
Frequency  
550 VA maximum  
Power  
(I/P max)  
208/240 volt, 15 Amp supply  
Outlet Type  
As local power specifications vary, see a qualified local electrician when  
Note 1:  
planning your power requirements.  
The Supplied power must be single-phase 240 or three-phase 208 Y, and  
Note 2:  
must have a system ground conductor.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 57 of 332  
Table 13  
AC input requirements for each NTDK91 and NTDK92 (Germany)  
Recommended: 230 volts  
Voltage  
Maximum limits: 180 and 250 volts  
Single phase  
50 Hz  
Frequency  
550 VA maximum  
Power  
(I/P max)  
16A  
Fuse  
Receptacles by DIN regulation  
Outlet Type  
Site requirements  
The following is a list of required site features for an optimal Option 11C  
Mini AC-powered system installation.  
If a dedicated panel cannot provide the conditions listed below, use an  
Isolation Transformer. Refer to “Alternative AC-powered installation” on  
page 58.  
Dedicated circuit breaker panel  
A dedicated circuit breaker panel provides power only to the Option 11C  
Mini system and its related hardware, such as TTYs and printers  
Note: You can not always power a complete system from a single  
circuit-breaker panel. For example, when chassis are located remotely.  
Insulated copper ground conductor  
Insulated copper ground conductor connects the ground bus in the  
dedicated panel to the main service panel ground or building ground  
reference. Route the insulated copper ground conductor through the  
same conduit as the supply conductors that feed the panel.  
Isolated-ground receptacles  
All outlets connected to the dedicated panel must be of the isolated  
ground type. Use a separate circuit for each device connected to the  
panel. Outlets that provide service to the chassis must be close enough so  
that the power cord can reach the chassis power supply.  
Isolated ground bus in the electrical panel, where permitted by local  
codes  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 58 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Location of power outlets  
The maximum distance between a power outlet and the system chassis  
depends on the length of the power cord. In North America, the power cord  
is 9 ft 10 in. (3000 mm). In countries outside North America, the power cord  
is 8 ft 2 in. (2490 mm).  
Alternative AC-powered installation  
If a dedicated panel cannot provide optimal conditions, use an Isolation  
Transformer with the following characteristics:  
120/208/240 VAC input, over-current protected at primary  
120/208/240 VAC available at secondary outputs, each  
circuit breaker-protected  
Completely isolate primary and secondary windings from one another  
Approved for use locally as a stand-alone user product (CSA, UL, or  
other locally recognized clear markings)  
Capable of providing power to all Option 11C Mini system equipment  
operating at the same time at full load  
Equipment not related to the Option 11C Mini system must not be  
powered from a transformer that provides service the Option 11C Mini  
system.  
Uninterruptible Power Supply  
For backup AC power, you can use an Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS)  
to feed the Option 11C Mini. The power requirement for a UPS is 550 VA per  
system. The maximum power requirement for a Main Chassis and a Chassis  
Expander on the same breaker is 1100 VA. Install the UPS according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
Isolation transformer ground  
The transformer ground must have the following characteristics:  
Separate grounds for primary and secondary windings, rather than a  
common ground  
A “clean” and permanent SPG reference at the transformer secondary for  
the Option 11C Mini system  
Make sure that the ground conductors inside the transformer are sized  
correctly.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 59 of 332  
Receptacles  
Receptacle requirements are as follows:  
When installed on the wall, install receptacles within reach of the chassis  
power cords.  
All receptacles served by the secondary must be of the isolated ground  
type  
The ground prong of each outlet must be connected by an insulated  
conductor to the system SPG  
If the transformer has an isolated secondary ground lug, use it as the SPG. If  
it does not, use the chassis ground of the transformer as the Single Point  
Ground.  
Installing an Isolation Transformer  
Transformers with pluggable power cords:  
1
Connect the power cords of all Option 11C Mini system equipment to the  
outlets on the transformer secondary.  
2
Secure an insulated conductor between the ground lug on the Main  
Chassis of the Option 11C Mini and the SPG lug on the transformer.  
Place a “DO NOT DISCONNECT” tag on it.  
Do not fasten or tie this conductor to the power cable feeding the Option  
11C Mini.  
Note: Power all equipment related with the Option 11C Mini from the  
secondary of the transformer only. Ground all equipment to the  
secondary isolated ground lug. Do not connect equipment that is not  
related to the Option 11C Mini system to the isolation transformer that  
powers it.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 60 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Power the transformer primary through a dedicated circuit. If the primary has  
a pluggable cord, make an additional ground connection between the  
Option 11C Mini SPG and a known building ground reference. This  
connection is very important for safe and reliable operation.  
CAUTION  
Do not connect any system ground lines of the Option 11C Mini to  
structural steel or water pipes, or other unreliable ground paths. Use a  
ground point known to be “clean” and permanent. Place a “DO NOT  
DISCONNECT” tag on it. Figure 7 on page 61 shows the pluggable  
cord connections.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 61 of 332  
Figure 7  
Typical pluggable cord Isolation Transformer wiring plan  
Note 4  
Note 1  
Shared  
Isolation  
Transformer  
Note 7  
Note 5  
Panel  
120V IG  
Receptacle  
••  
240V IG  
Receptacle  
Note 9  
Note 8  
Neutral Bus  
Gnd Bus  
Note 2  
Note 6  
Note 3  
Option 11  
Cabinet  
Gnd Lug  
Notes:  
1
Power source is site dependent. It may be from a shared panel or transformer. Wiring may vary  
accordingly. Wiring to panel must be housed in conduit.  
2
Make SPG at the transformer secondary. If the transformer secondary has no isolated secondary  
ground lug, make SPG by connecting all system ground lines to the chassis lug on the transformer  
case. An insulated ground connection must be made between the SPG and a known building ground  
reference, as per Note 3.  
3
Terminate the Option 11 SPG insulated ground conductor as near as possible to the main building  
ground reference. Isolate the ground bus from panel housing if permitted by local codes. Conductor  
should be minimum AWG #6 (metric #40) at all points.  
4
5
6
Wiring to receptacles must be in conduit unless they are mounted on the transformer case.  
Connection can be made by metallic conduit. Additional copper conductor recommended.  
Minimum AWG #6 (metric #40) insulated copper conductor connected to FGND lug on the Option 11  
cabinet. Route separately from AC power cable.  
7
Separate breaker required for each Option 11 Main cabinet. Breakers must be mounted on transformer  
if the receptacles are. If they are in a panel served by the transformer secondary, all connections  
between the receptacles and transformer must be in conduit. The Main Chassis and the Chassis  
Expander can coexist on the same breaker.  
8
9
Connect secondary neutral (X0) to system SPG.  
Conduit required.  
553-8322.EPS  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 62 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Transformers without pluggable power cords  
If the transformer does not have a pluggable cord, hardwire the transformer  
to an electrical panel. Route all wires (including grounds) through a single  
conduit.  
Some electrical codes permit the use of conduit as the only ground conductor  
between pieces of equipment.  
Run a separate insulated ground conductor through the conduit to hold chassis  
grounds together. Such a conductor maintains the safety ground connection  
in the event that the conduit becomes corroded or disconnected.  
Run all ground lines through the same conduit as the phase conductors that  
serve the equipment. Figure 8 on page 63 shows the Isolation transformer  
connections.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 63 of 332  
Figure 8  
Typical hardwired Isolation Transformer wiring plan  
Note 4  
Note 1  
Shared  
Isolation  
Transformer  
Note 7  
Note 5  
Panel  
120V IG  
Receptacle  
• •  
240V IG  
Receptacle  
Note 8  
Neutral Bus  
Gnd Bus  
Note 4  
Note 2  
Note 6  
Note 3  
Option 11  
Cabinet  
Gnd Lug  
Notes:  
1
Power source is site dependent. It may be from a shared panel or transformer. Wiring may vary  
accordingly. Wiring to panel must be housed in conduit.  
2
Make SPG at the transformer secondary. If the transformer secondary has no isolated secondary  
ground lug, make SPG by connecting all system ground lines to the chassis lug on the transformer  
case. An insulated ground connection must be made between the SPG and a known building ground  
reference, as per Note 3.  
3
4
Terminate the Option 11 SPG insulated ground conductor as near as possible to the main building  
ground reference. Isolate the ground bus from panel housing if permitted by local codes. Conductor  
should be minimum AWG #6 (metric #40) at all points.  
Transformer primary wires must be in conduit. Wiring to receptacles must be in conduit unless they are  
mounted on the transformer case.  
5
6
Connection can be made by metallic conduit. Additional copper conductor recommended.  
Minimum AWG #6 (metric #40) insulated copper conductor connected to FGND lug on the Option 11  
cabinet. Route separately from AC power cable.  
7
8
Separate breaker required for each Option 11 Main cabinet. Breakers must be mounted on transformer  
if the receptacles are. If they are in a panel served by the transformer secondary, all connections  
between the receptacles and transformer must be in conduit. The Main Chassis and the Chassis  
Expander can coexist on the same breaker.  
Connect secondary neutral (X0) to system SPG.  
553-8323.EPS  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 64 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Power consumption worksheets for the Option 11C Mini  
system  
Use the worksheets (Tables 15 to 17) in this section to determine the power  
consumption for the Option 11C Mini system. Refer to Table 14 for the  
circuit card power consumption.  
Table 14  
Circuit card power consumption  
% active sets  
(off-hook)  
Power  
consumption  
Circuit card  
Type  
NT6R16  
NT5K02  
NT8D02  
NT8D03  
NT9D09  
NT8D14  
NT8D15  
NTDK16  
NTDK97  
NTAK02  
NTAK03  
NTAK09  
NTAK10  
NTAK79  
NTBK50  
NTBK22  
Meridian Mail Mini  
steady state  
50%  
35W  
26W  
25W  
26W  
26W  
28W  
29W  
75w  
Flexible analog line card  
Digital line card  
100%  
50%  
Analog line card  
Message-waiting line card  
Universal trunk card  
E&M trunk card  
50%  
DID-enabled  
N/A  
48-port Digital Line Card  
Mini System Controller  
SDI/DCH card  
100%  
N/A  
15 w  
10W  
8W  
N/A  
TDS/DTR card  
N/A  
1.5Mb DTI/PRI card  
2.0 Mb DTI card  
N/A  
10W  
12 W  
12 W  
12 W  
12 W  
N/A  
2.0 Mb PRI card  
N/A  
2.0 Mb PRI card  
N/A  
MISP card  
N/A  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 65 of 332  
Table 15  
Option 11C Mini power consumption: Main Chassis  
Power  
Slot  
Circuit card  
Type  
consumption  
from Table 14  
1
NTDK97  
MSC  
15 w  
2
3
4, 5, 6  
NTDK16  
48 port DLC  
Total  
75w  
Table 16  
Option 11C Mini power consumption: Chassis Expander  
Power  
Slot  
Circuit card  
Type  
consumption  
from Table 14  
7
8
9
10  
Total  
Table 17  
Total Option 11C Mini system power consumption  
Pout Main (total for slots 1-6 in main chassis)  
Pout Expan (total for slots 7-10 in the chassis  
expander)  
Total  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 66 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Auxiliary equipment power  
Terminals, printers, modems, and other data units used with the Option 11C  
Mini require special wiring considerations.  
Power for system equipment in the switch room must:  
be powered from the same panel or transformer as the Option 11C Mini  
be grounded to the same panel or transformer as the Option 11C Mini  
be labeled at the panel to prevent interruption that is not authorized  
not be controlled by a switch between the breaker and the equipment  
Service receptacles for Option 11C Mini AC systems and related equipment  
must be:  
of the isolated ground type, such as NEMA IG5-15  
rated for 120 or 240 V, 15 or 20A, 50-60 Hz, 3-pole, 3-wire, grounded  
grounded to the same location so as to form a Single Point Ground  
Modem requirements  
Equip the system with a modem to allow remote access. Refer to “Modem  
setup requirements” on page 192 for information about setting up the  
modems recommended for use with the Option 11C Mini system.  
Note: In the UK, British Telecom RACE modems require a Modem  
Eliminator (NULL Modem without hardware handshaking) A0378652  
F-F converter or A0381016 M-F converter.  
With or without Meridian Mail  
The minimum requirement is a 1200 bps auto-answer modem.  
If an error-correcting modem is connected to the Option 11C Mini, all  
flow-control and error-correcting functionality of the modem must be  
disabled to ensure correct operation. Refer to the modem manufacturer’s  
instructions for information.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements Page 67 of 332  
Maintenance and administration terminals  
Refer to “Terminal setup” on page 201 for information about setting up  
terminals recommended for use with the Option 11C Mini system.  
Under some conditions, you require a Modem Eliminator (NULL Modem  
without hardware handshaking) A0601397 F-F converter or A0601396 M-F  
to interface the TTY to the system.  
The following describes the minimum requirements for a TTY device:  
Without Meridian Mail  
When the system does not have Meridian Mail installed, and it will not have  
Meridian Mail installed in the future, the minimum requirement is a VT100  
compatible device.  
With Meridian Mail  
With Meridian Mail installed, use a VT220 compatible device.  
On-site access  
Equip each system with an M2616 or M2008 telephone with display. These  
telephones act as maintenance telephones.  
You can use many different TTY terminals to access the Option 11C Mini.  
However, a VT220 terminal is recommended as an on-site terminal. You can  
use this terminal to perform service changes, maintenance and diagnostic  
functions, and Meridian Mail administration activities.  
Remote access  
Although you can use several types of modems to access the system, a 2400  
baud auto-answer modem is the recommended modem. A 1200 baud modem  
is the minimum requirement. You can use the modem to perform service  
changes, maintenance and diagnostic functions, and Meridian Mail  
administration activities from a remote location.  
Note: You can perform additional maintenance functions through  
remote access on the Option 11C Mini. For additional information, refer  
to the Customer Configuration Backup and Restore Guide  
(553-3011-330).  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 68 of 332  
Chapter 3 — System and site requirements  
Meridian Administration Tools  
The Option 11C Mini supports the Meridian Administration Tools (MAT)  
application. For information about MAT requirements and installing MAT  
for the Option 11C Mini, refer to the MAT User Guides.  
Cross-connect terminal requirements  
Allow for future expansion and equipment changes at the cross-connect  
terminal.  
The cross-connect terminal must have enough space for connecting blocks to  
terminate the following wires:  
five 25-pair cables from each Main Chassis  
four 25-pair cables from the Chassis Expander  
four conductors for the AUX cable from the Main Chassis  
one 25-pair cable from each QUA6 PFTU  
wiring from telephone sets and trunks  
The BIX cross-connect system is recommended for use with the Option 11C  
Mini system. However, use of this system is not mandatory. You can use  
some other cross-connect systems (for example, the Krone Test Jack Frame  
for the UK and the Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal for Germany).  
Only allow authorized personnel to access the Krone Test Jack Frame. Install  
the Krone Test Jack Frame in a locked room or in an environment that  
prevents free access to the equipment. The Krone Test Jack Frame must meet  
this safety requirement to receive approval.  
You can find information about the BIX cross-connect system in the  
following documents:  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Description  
(631-4511-100)  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Installation and  
Servicing (631-4511-200)  
Refer to “Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal”  
on page 169 for additional information about the BIX, Krone Test Jack  
Frame, and Reichle Masari cross-connect terminals.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
82  
Page 69 of 332  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment  
layout plan and a card slot assignment  
plan  
Take some time to plan the installation of the Option 11C Mini. This  
preparation helps to make sure that the system performs correctly. Develop a  
layout plan for the equipment to determine where you will position each  
system component.  
Give consideration to the lengths of the different cables, so that you make the  
best use of available space. Refer to Table 5 on page 37 of this guide for a  
description of Option 11C Mini cable and wire specifications.  
Preparation of the site according to the plan is very important. Make sure that  
the site is ready to accept the equipment. Make sure that items, such as power  
outlets and backboards, are installed correctly.  
Equipment layout plan  
General layout guidelines  
CAUTION  
Make sure that the mounting surface can support at least 100 lb  
(45 kg).  
The following are the installation options for the Option 11C Mini chassis:  
wall installation  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Page 70 of 332  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
— vertically on a wall  
— horizontally on a wall  
in a rack/cabinet  
on a table  
Each Option 11C Mini chassis measures 8.4 in. (213 mm) high by 17.2 in.  
Equipment layout plan for installing the chassis on a wall  
horizontally and vertically  
Figure 9 on page 71 shows a typical wall layout, using BIX cross-connect  
equipment, for installing the chassis on a wall in a horizontal position.  
Figure 10 on page 72 shows a typical wall layout, using BIX cross-connect  
equipment, for installing the chassis on a wall in a vertical position. Use of  
other types of terminal blocks and equipment can change the layout. As a  
result, if required, adjust the height at which you place the chassis in relation  
to other equipment. If required, also adjust the distances between the power  
outlets and the backboard.  
Use the following guidelines to position the system equipment on a wall.  
It is recommended that you fasten a 3/4 in. (20 mm) plywood (or other  
material like plywood) backboard to the surface of the wall. Fasten the  
Option 11C Mini equipment to this backboard.  
When planning for a system with DTI/PRI capability, allow space on the  
backboard for the channel service unit (CSU).  
Leave at least 6 in. (155 mm) above the mounting bracket and any  
obstruction (such as a pipe or conduit) so that there is room to lift the  
chassis on and off the bracket.  
Leave at least 12 in. (305 mm) between the top of a chassis and the  
ceiling to make sure that there is enough ventilation for the system.  
Leave 10 in. (255 mm) between the bottom of the lower chassis and the  
floor to prevent water damage.  
If you use the NTAK92 Off-premises protection module, allow for  
correct installation (according to local practices).  
Make sure power outlets are within reach of each system chassis. See  
Table 5 on page 37 for cable and wire specifications.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 71 of 332  
Figure 9  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a wall in a horizontal position  
Allow 24 in. (610 mm) at the top  
for miscellaneous equipment  
Leave at least  
2 in. (51 mm)  
between edge  
of backboard  
and corner of room  
Draw 2 vertical lines  
18.5 in. (470 mm)apart  
Draw horizontal line  
for bottom hole of  
ear bracket  
Distance from  
edge of backboard  
to isolated  
ground outlet  
0 - 27 in. (686 mm)  
S
K
R
O
W
T
Main  
Chassis  
NE  
Maximum of  
21 in. (533 mm)  
Minimum of  
12 in. (305 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
12 in. (305 mm)  
10 in. (254 mm)  
Each chassis measures  
8.4 in. x 17.2 in. x 12.8 in.  
(213 mm x 437 mm x 325 mm)  
Recommended lowest position  
for chassis installation is  
10 in. (254 mm) from floor  
553-9034  
Note: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 72 of 332  
Figure 10  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a wall in a vertical position  
Leave at least  
12 in. (305 mm)  
between edge  
of backboard  
and corner of  
room to allow for  
card insertion  
Allow 24 in. (610 mm) at the top  
for miscellaneous equipment  
Draw horizontal  
line for bottom  
hole of wall mount  
bracket  
Main  
Chassis  
Spacing is  
21 in. (530 mm)  
Distance from edge of  
backboard to  
isolated ground outlet  
0 - 27 in. (686 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
12 in. (305 mm)  
10 inches  
(254 mm)  
Each chassis measures  
8.4 in. x 17.2 in. x 12.8 in.  
(213 mm x 437 mm x 325 mm)  
Recommended lowest position  
for chassis installation is  
10 inches (254 mm) from floor  
553-9035  
Note: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 73 of 332  
Equipment layout plan for installing the chassis on a table  
To install an Option 11C Mini on a table, the available space on top of the  
table must be large enough to hold the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander.  
See Figure 11.  
Note 1: If you are installing only a Main Chassis now, leave enough  
space for additional chassis to avoid problems in the future.  
Note 2: You can place the Main Chassis directly on top of the Chassis  
Expander.  
Leave enough wall space for the cross-connect terminal, the cross-connect  
cables, and other equipment (such as a power supply for digit displays on  
telephones).  
CAUTION  
Leave at least 12 in. (305 mm) of space between the top of the chassis  
and any obstruction (such as a shelf) to permit enough air circulation.  
Do not place the chassis on the floor, as dust can enter the system. This  
results in damage to the system.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 74 of 332  
Figure 11  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a table  
Air inlets and exhausts on chassis  
clear of obstructions  
Main  
Chassis  
S
K
R
O
TW  
E
N
S
K
R
Chassis  
Expander  
O
W
T
NE  
12 in. (305 mm)  
553-9029  
Note: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 75 of 332  
Equipment layout plan for installing the chassis in a  
rack/cabinet  
You can install the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander in a 19 inch  
rack/cabinet. There is also space in the rack/cabinet for additional pieces of  
Data Communications Equipment. In a rack/cabinet configuration, the lowest  
recommended installation position for the chassis is 1.75 inches (44 mm)  
from the floor. See Figure 12.  
Note: The 19 inch rack/cabinet does not come with the Option 11C Mini  
system.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 76 of 332  
Figure 12  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
Typical layout for installing the chassis in a rack/cabinet  
Space for  
additional data  
communications  
equipment  
Main  
Chassis  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
Maximum  
of 21 in.  
(533 mm)  
Minimum  
of 8.75 in.  
(222 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
Isolated  
ground outlet  
Space for  
12 in. (305 mm)  
additional data  
communications  
equipment  
553-9036  
Recommended lowest  
position for chassis  
installation is 1.75 in. (44 mm)  
from bottom of rack  
Note: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 77 of 332  
Card slot assignments  
Prepare a card slot assignment plan in advance. The card slot allocation plan  
shows circuit card to slot assignments. See the most current Option 11C Mini  
product bulletins for minimum version requirements.  
Note 1: You must insert the NTDK97 MSC card in Slot 0 of the Main  
Chassis. The MSC card does not support any optional daughterboards.  
Note 2: Slot 4 accepts the NTDK16 48-port DLC card only. However,  
you can place a card that takes two slots in slot 3, and it can overlap into  
slot 4.  
You can install the following cards in slots 1, 2, and 3 of the Main Chassis:  
NTAK09  
NTAK10  
NTBK50  
NTAK79  
NTBK22  
NT6D70 (when used as a clock controller)  
NTRB21  
The NTAK09 supports the following optional daughterboards:  
the NTAK20 Clock Controller  
the NTAK93 D-channel Interface  
the NTBK51 DDCH Daughterboard  
The NTBK50 supports the following optional daughterboards:  
NTAK20 Clock Controller  
NTBK51 DDCH daughterboard or the NTAK93 D-channel Interface  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 78 of 332  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
To prepare a plan for card slot assignment, write the total number of circuit  
cards required for the installation in Table 18.  
Table 18  
Card slot assignment plan  
Number of  
cards  
Card  
Card slot  
Used only in the Main Chassis  
NTDK97 MSC  
0 only  
4 only  
1
NTDK16 48-port DLC  
NTAK02 SDI/DCH  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR  
NTAK09 1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI  
NTRB21 1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI  
NTAK10 2.0 Mbit DTI  
NTAK79 2.0 Mbit PRI  
NTBK50 2.0 Mbit PRI  
NT5K20 Tone Detector  
NT5K48 Tone Detector  
NTBK22 MISP  
NT6D70 SILC  
Used only in the Chassis Expander  
NT6R16 Meridian Mail Mini  
Used in the Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander  
NT8D02 Digital Line Card  
NT8D03 Analog line card  
NT8D09 Message Waiting  
NT8D14 Universal Trunk  
10 only  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 79 of 332  
Table 18  
Card slot assignment plan (Continued)  
Number of  
cards  
Card  
Card slot  
NT8D16 Digitone Receiver  
NT8D15 E&M Trunk  
NT7D16 Data Access  
NT6D70 SILC (See Note 1)  
NT6D71 UILC  
NT5K02 XFALC  
NT5K18 XFCOT  
NT5K17 XDDI  
NT5K19 XFEM  
NT5K36 XDID/DOD  
NT5K21 XMFC/MFE  
NTAG26 XMFR  
Note 1: Install the NT6D70 SILC card in the Main Chassis (Slots 1, 2,  
or 3) if it is used as a clock controller.  
CAUTION  
If you use NE-A25B cables instead of NTAK19AA and NTAK19BA  
cables with the NTAK02 and NTAK03 cards, continue with caution.  
NE-A25B cables are not wired out to station equipment or trunk  
circuits. NE-A25B cables can only be wired out to SDI circuits.  
Make sure to first allocate the cards that you must install in the Main Chassis.  
Fill the remaining card slots as required.  
If you plan on using the preassigned numbering plan with consecutive  
numbers, make sure you assign all line cards in consecutive card slots.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 80 of 332  
Figure 13  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
See Figures 13 and 14 for the card slot assignments in the Main Chassis and  
Chassis Expander.  
Card slot assignments for the Main Chassis  
Main Chassis  
LC  
48 D  
T
LO  
4
T
S
SLO  
3
T
SLO  
2
T
SLO  
1
Slots 4, 5, 6  
NTDK16 48-port  
DLC ONLY  
T
SLO  
0
C
PU  
Slot 3 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 2 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 1 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 0 - NTDK97 MSC  
553-9025  
Note 1: Refer to Table 18 on page 78 for a list of cards that you can  
insert in the Main Chassis.  
Note 2: Slot 4 accepts the NTDK16 48-port DLC card only. However,  
you can place a card that takes two slots in slot 3, and it can overlap into  
slot 4.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan Page 81 of 332  
Figure 14  
Card slot assignments for the Chassis Expander  
Chassis Expander  
T
O
L
1
S
0
T
O
L
L
L
S
S
S
9
T
O
8
T
O
7
Slot 10 - Meridian Mail  
Mini or any IPE card  
Slot 9 - Any IPE card  
Slot 8 - Any IPE card  
Slot 7 - Any IPE card  
553-9032  
Note: Refer to Table 18 on page 78 for a list of cards that you can insert  
in the Chassis Expander.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 82 of 332  
Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90  
Page 83 of 332  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information  
This chapter includes regulatory information for American, Canadian, and  
International installations of the Option 11C Mini.  
System approval  
All global markets approve the Option 11C Mini system. The Option 11C  
Mini has a regulatory label on the back of each system chassis. This label  
contains national and international regulatory information.  
Notice for United States installations  
The Option 11C Mini system follows Part 68 of the FCC rules. A label  
containing the FCC registration number and Ringer Equivalence Number  
(REN) for the Option 11C Mini equipment is on the back of each system  
chassis. Provide this information to your telephone company, if it requests  
FCC registration number and REN information.  
Importance of Ringer Equivalence Number  
The FCC regulation label includes the Ringer Equivalence Number (REN).  
This number represents the electrical load applied to your telephone line after  
you plug the PBX into the wall jack. The telephone line for your premises  
does not operate correctly if the total ringer load exceeds the capability of the  
telephone company’s Central Office (CO) equipment. If there are too many  
ringers connected to the line, there may not be enough energy to ring your  
system. If the ringer load exceeds the system’s capabilities, you may also  
have problems dialing telephone numbers.  
For more information about the total REN permitted for your telephone line,  
contact your local telephone company. However, as a guideline, a total REN  
of five should allow for normal operation of your equipment.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Page 84 of 332  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information  
If your Meridian 1 Option 11C Mini equipment causes harm to the telephone  
network, the telephone company can discontinue your service temporarily.  
The telephone company can ask you to disconnect the equipment from the  
network until the problem is corrected. The telephone company can ask you  
to disconnect the equipment until you are sure the equipment is working  
correctly. If possible, the telephone company will notify you before they  
disconnect the equipment. You will be notified of your right to file a  
complaint with the FCC.  
Your telephone company can make changes in its facilities, equipment,  
operations, or procedures that can affect the correct operation of your  
equipment. If the telephone company does make changes, they will give you  
advance notice. With advance notice, it is possible for you to make  
arrangements to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with your Option 11C Mini equipment, contact your  
authorized distributor or service center in the United States for repair or  
warranty information.  
Hearing aid compatibility  
All proprietary telephones used with the Meridian 1 Option 11C Mini meet  
with the requirements of FCC Part 68 Rule 68.316 for hearing aid  
compatibility.  
Notice for Canadian installations  
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment (Industry Canada  
was the Canadian Department of Communications). This certification means  
that the equipment meets certain operations, safety, and protection  
requirements for telecommunications networks. The Department does not  
guarantee that the equipment will operate to the user’s satisfaction.  
The Load Number (LN) assigned to each terminal device is the percentage of  
the total load that can be connected to a telephone loop using the device. This  
number prevents overload. The termination on a loop can have any  
combination of devices, provided that the total of the Load Numbers does not  
exceed 100. An alphabetical suffix is also defined in the Load Number for the  
appropriate ringing type (A or B), if necessary. For example, LN = 20 A  
indicates a Load Number of 20 and an “A” type ringer.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information Page 85 of 332  
Before you install any equipment, must make sure that it can connect to the  
facilities of the local telecommunications company. You must install the  
equipment using an acceptable method of connection. In some cases, a  
certified connector assembly (telephone extension cord) can extend the  
company’s inside wiring associated with a single line individual service.  
Understand that compliance with the above conditions does not always  
prevent degradation of service.  
An authorized Canadian maintenance faciltiy, identified by the supplier, must  
make repairs to certified equipment. If you make repairs or modifications to  
this equipment (or if the equipment malfunctions), the telephone company  
can ask you to disconnect the equipment.  
Make sure that the electrical ground connections of the power utility,  
telephone lines, and internal metallic water pipe system, if present, connect  
together. This precaution is for the users’ protection, and is very important in  
rural areas.  
CAUTION  
The Option 11C Mini frame ground of each system chassis must be  
tied to a reliable building ground reference.  
WARNING  
Contact your local electrical inspection authority or electrician to  
make electrical ground connections.  
Notice for international installations  
If there is not enough planning or technical information available for your  
country of operation, contact your regional distributor or authority for help.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 86 of 332  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information  
European compliance information  
The Option 11C Mini meets the following European technical regulations:  
CTR 1, CTR 2, CTR 3, CTR 4, CTR 6, CTR 10, CTR 12, CTR 13, CTR 15,  
CTR 17, CTR 22, CTR 24, and the I-ETS 300 131.  
Supported interfaces  
Analog interfaces are approved based on national or European specifications.  
Digital interfaces are approved based on European specifications.  
Safety specifications  
The Option 11C Mini system meets the following European safety  
specifications: EN 60825, EN 60950, EN 41003  
Electromagnetic Compatibility  
Table 19 shows the Electromagentic Compatibility (EMC) specifications for  
the Option 11C Mini.  
Table 19  
Option 11C Mini EMC specifications  
Emission:  
EN 55022  
EN 50082-1  
EN 300329  
ETS 300446  
Immunity:  
EN 61000-4-2  
EN 61000-4-3  
EN 61000 4-4  
Electrostatic discharge  
Electromagnetic field  
Fast transient burst  
Canadian and United States Network connections  
Give the information contained in Table 20 on page 88 to the local telephone  
company when ordering standard network interface jacks for the Option 11C  
Mini system.  
Note: Table 20 on page 88 includes columns for system port  
identification, Facility Interface Code (FIC), Service Order Code (SOC),  
USOC jack identification, and the related Nortel Networks equipment  
part numbers.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information Page 87 of 332  
FCC compliance: registered equipment for Direct Inward Dial  
(DID) calls  
Part 68 of the FCC’s rules state that equipment registered for Direct Inward  
Dial (DID) calls must provide correct answer supervision.  
The definition of correct answer supervision is as follows:  
DID equipment returns answer supervision to the Central Office when  
DID calls are:  
— answered by the called station  
— answered by the attendant  
— routed to a recorded announcement that can be administered by the  
CPE user  
— routed to a dial prompt.  
DID equipment returns answer supervision on all DID calls forwarded to  
the Central Office. Acceptable exceptions are if:  
— a call is not answered  
— a busy tone is received  
— a reorder tone is received.  
* RJ with CA for Canada  
Radio and TV interference  
Information for the United States  
The Option 11C Mini follows Part 15 of the FCC rules in the United States.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
The Option 11C Mini must not cause harmful interference.  
The Option 11C Mini must accept any interference received, including  
interference that can cause undesirable operation.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 88 of 332  
Table 20  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information  
Network connection specifications  
Facility  
Interface  
Code  
Service  
Order  
Code  
Manufacturer  
Network network interface  
Ports MTS/WATS  
REN  
Jacks  
port designation  
2-Wire, LSA, L-S  
02LS2  
9.0F  
9.0F  
9.0F  
1.1B  
RJ21X  
NT8D14  
(2-Wire, Local  
Switched Access,  
Loop-Start)  
CA21X*  
2-Wire, LSA, G-S  
02GS2  
1.1B  
0.0B  
RJ21X  
NT8D14  
NT8D14  
(2-Wire, Local  
Switched Access,  
Ground-Start)  
CA21X*  
2-Wire, LSA, R-B  
02RV2-T  
RJ21X  
(2-Wire, Local  
CA21X*  
Switched Access,  
Reverse-Battery)  
1.544 Mbit OSI, SF  
04DV9-B  
04Dv9-C  
6.0P  
6.0P  
N/A  
N/A  
RJ48  
CA48*  
NTAK09  
NTAK09  
1.544 MbitOSI, SF  
RJ48  
CA48*  
Analog PL facilities  
E&M Tie Trunk  
TL11M  
TL31M  
9.0F  
9.0F  
N/A  
N/A  
RJ2EX  
NT8D15  
NT8D15  
(TIE line, lossless,  
2-wire type 1 E&M)  
CA2EX*  
E&M 4-Wire DRTT  
RJ2GX  
(TIE line, lossless, dial  
repeating, 2-wire type 1  
E&M)  
CA2GX*  
E&M 4-Wire DRTT  
TL32M  
9.0F  
N/A  
RJ2HX  
NT8D15  
(TIE line, lossless, dial  
repeating, 2-wire type 2  
E&M)  
CA2HX*  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information Page 89 of 332  
If the Option 11C Mini causes interference to radio or television reception,  
try to correct the interference using the following measures. You can  
determine if there is interference by placing a telephone call while  
monitoring.  
Move the receiving TV or radio antenna where this can be done safely.  
Move the TV or radio in relation to the telephone equipment.  
If necessary, ask a qualified radio or television technician or supplier for  
additional information. Also, you can refer to the document “How to Identify  
and Resolve Radio-TV Interference”, prepared by the Federal  
Communications Commission. This document is available from:  
U.S. Government Printing Office  
Washington DC 20402  
Information for Canada  
The Option 11C Mini system does not exceed Class A limits for radio noise  
emissions from digital apparatus. The radio interference regulations of  
Industry Canada sets out these limits.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 90 of 332  
Chapter 5 — Regulatory information  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
100  
Page 91 of 332  
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C  
Mini  
This chapter contains tools and readiness checklists. Before beginning the  
installation, make sure you have all the tools necessary to install the Option  
11C Mini. Make sure you have checked all site requirements, received all  
equipment, and have prepared an equipment layout plan and a card slot  
assignment plan.  
This chapter also provides a high-level summary of installation procedures  
for the Option 11C Mini. Where applicable, the summary contains references  
to chapters that describe the procedures in more detail.  
Tools checklist  
To install the system correctly, make sure that the following tools are  
available before you begin to assemble the components:  
different types of screwdrivers  
a tape measure  
a level  
pliers such as side cutters and longnose pliers  
an ECOS 1023 POW-R-MATE or similar type of test meter  
appropriate cable terminating tools  
a drill for making lead holes for screws  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 92 of 332  
Readiness checklist  
Have you:  
read all safety instructions in “Chapter 7 — Important safety  
instructions” on page 101?  
made sure that you received all the equipment that you ordered?  
checked for all power requirements?  
checked for correct grounding facilities?  
developed an equipment layout plan for the system? See “Equipment  
layout plan” on page 69.  
completed the card slot assignment plan? See “Card slot assignments” on  
page 77.  
assembled all the tools required to continue with the installation?  
If you have completed all of the above items, you are ready to start the  
installation of the Option 11C Mini system.  
The following list provides a summary of the Option 11C Mini installation  
procedures. Refer to the chapters and procedures indicated at the end of each  
step for important and detailed information related to installation.  
2
3
4
instructions” on page 101.  
Make sure that you have read and completed the instructions contained  
in the Planning section of this guide.  
Make sure that system and site requirements have been met. See  
“Chapter 3 — System and site requirements” on page 45.  
Make sure that you have created the equipment layout plan and card slot  
assignment plan. See “Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan  
and a card slot assignment plan” on page 69.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini Page 93 of 332  
5
If your Option 11C Mini system requires earthquake bracing, refer to  
“Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes” on  
For your system to be braced against earthquakes, you must install the  
chassis on a wall in a vertical position.  
6
7
Locate the box containing the Option 11C Mini equipment.  
page 115. Refer to one of the following procedures, depending on the  
— Procedure 2: “Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a  
vertical position” on page 118  
— Procedure 3: “Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a  
horizontal position” on page 123  
page 128  
— Procedure 5: “Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis in a 19 inch  
8
9
Install the Chassis Expander. See “Chapter 10 — Connecting the Chassis  
Expander to the Main Chassis” on page 135. You can skip this step if  
your system only has one chassis.  
Install the Chassis Expander the same way as the Main Chassis. Refer to  
Procedure 6: “Adding a Chassis Expander” on page 135. This procedure  
describes how to connect the Main Chassis to the Chassis Expander by  
using the two NTDK95 CE-MUX/ DS-30X cables.  
Install the chassis ground wire for the Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander at this site. See “Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground” on  
page 139.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 94 of 332  
Refer to one of the following procedures:  
— Procedure 8: “UK grounding procedure for the Option 11C Mini  
chassis” on page 144  
To ground multiple pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet when one or  
more pieces of equipment does not have a grounding lug, see “Grounding  
multiple pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet” on page 144.  
10 If you require a UPS, install the UPS according to the manufacturer’s  
instructions.  
11 If you have not already done so, remove the faceplate of the chassis.  
a
Loosen the quick-release screws on the faceplate of the chassis. See  
Figure 15.  
Figure 15  
Faceplate on the Option 11C Mini chassis  
Loosen the  
quick-release  
screws  
b
c
Lift the faceplate up.  
Remove the faceplate.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini Page 95 of 332  
12 Install the Mini System Controller (MSC) card and the 48-port Digital  
Line Card.  
a
Install the Security Device on the NTDK97 MSC card. Install the  
MSC card in CPU slot 0 of the Main Chassis. See Procedure 9  
“NTDK97 MSC installation” on page 153.  
b
Install the NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card in Slot 4 of the Main  
Chassis. See Procedure 10 “NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card  
installation” on page 156.  
The NTDK16 Digital Line Card is not required for the Option 11C  
Mini system to operate.  
13 Install the optional circuit cards that you wish to have in your Option 11C  
Mini system. Refer to “Optional circuit cards” on page 156 and the ISDN  
Refer to the following procedures:  
— Procedure 19: “Installing the BIX cross-connect terminal” on  
page 171  
— Procedure 21: “Installing the Krone Test Jack Frame (UK)” on  
15 Install the cables from the chassis to the cross-connect terminal. See  
“Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal” on  
— Install the PFTUs, if provided. See “Chapter 14 — Installing Power  
Failure Transfer Units” on page 185. Refer to Procedure 23:  
“Installing the PFTU” on page 185.  
16 Connect the SDI port cable at the back of the chassis. See “Chapter 15 —  
Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports” on page 191. Refer to  
Procedure 24: “Connecting SDI ports on the MSC card” on page 193.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 96 of 332  
17 If Ethernet is required, insert an industry-standard Medium Access Unit  
(MAU) directly into the Ethernet connector at the back of the chassis.  
The Option 11C Mini system does not include the MAU. Insert the  
Ethernet cable into this MAU. See “Chapter 15 — Installing and  
connecting SDI and Ethernet ports” on page 191. Refer to Procedure 26:  
“Connecting the Ethernet cable” on page 206.  
18 Make sure that the DIP switch settings on the power supply are set to the  
correct values for ringing voltage, ringing frequency, and message  
waiting voltage. See Table 2 on page 33 for the DIP switch settings.  
matches the label on the back of the chassis. Turn the power switch to  
“ON”.  
20 Start and test system. See “Starting the Option 11C Mini” on page 209.  
Refer to the following procedures:  
using the MSC card” on page 210  
— Procedure 28: “Start-up procedure for a previously installed system”  
21 Install the system software. See “Installing software in a new system” on  
22 Connect the M2616 or the M2008 administration and maintenance  
telephone with display. See “Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones”  
on page 229.  
23 Install, if you have not already installed, and activate the telephones. See  
24 Connect the trunks to the system. See “Chapter 18 — Connecting the  
trunks” on page 253.  
25 Perform a system backup using Overlay 43.  
26 Install any remaining equipment. See “Chapter 19 — Connecting an  
external alarm” on page 279.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini Page 97 of 332  
27 Replace the faceplate.  
a
Fit the brackets at the bottom of the faceplate into the raised edge at  
the bottom of the chassis. Move slightly to the left. See Figure 16.  
Figure 16  
Aligning the faceplate with the chassis  
Fit brackets onto  
the front edge of  
the chassis  
b
Move the faceplate down so that it fits over the raised edge at the  
bottom of the chassis. See Figure 17.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 98 of 332  
Figure 17  
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini  
Fitting the faceplate on to the front of the chassis  
Push the faceplate  
down to fit onto the  
front edge of the chassis  
c
Slide the faceplate to the right, and tighten the quick-release screws  
into the two holes at the top of the chassis. See Figure 18.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini Page 99 of 332  
Figure 18  
Pushing the faceplate down into place to align with chassis  
Tighten the  
quick-release  
screws  
Push the faceplate  
to the right to align  
with the chassis  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 100 of 332  
Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
104  
Page 101 of 332  
Chapter 7 — Important safety  
instructions  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS  
This chapter provides important safety information for installing and  
using your telephone equipment. Make sure you have quick access to  
this chapter, so that you can use it as a reference tool.  
Symbols you must recognize  
When you see the symbol shown below on Option 11C Mini equipment or  
documentation, look for important operating and maintenance instructions.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 102 of 332  
Chapter 7 — Important safety instructions  
Safety instructions when installing telephone equipment  
The following are safety instructions for installing telephone equipment:  
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.  
Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is designed  
for wet locations.  
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the  
telephone line is disconnected at the network interface.  
Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.  
Safety instructions when using telephone equipment  
Always follow basic safety precautions when using telephone equipment.  
Following these safety precautions reduces the risk of fire, electric shock, and  
injury to persons, including the following:  
Follow all warnings and instructions marked on the product.  
Before you clean a telephone, remove the plug from the wall outlet. Do  
not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners. Use a damp cloth for cleaning.  
Do not use the telephone near water (for example, near a tub or sink).  
Do not place the telephone on a piece of furniture that is unstable. The  
telephone can fall, causing serious damage to the telephone.  
Slots and openings in the cabinet and the back or bottom of the telephone  
are for ventilation. These ventilation slots protect the telephone from  
overheating. Never block or cover these openings.  
Never block the openings on a telephone by placing the product on a  
surface like a bed, sofa, or rug. Never place the product near or over a  
radiator or heat register. Do not place the product in a built-in  
installation, unless there is correct ventilation.  
Only operate the product from the type of power source indicated on the  
marking label. If you are not sure of the type of power supply, check with  
your distributor.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7 — Important safety instructions Page 103 of 332  
Some equipment has a three-wire grounding plug. This type of plug has  
a third grounding pin. As a safety feature, the plug only fits into an  
isolated ground outlet. If you cannot insert the plug completely into the  
outlet, contact your electrician to replace the outlet.  
Some equipment has a polarized line plug. This type of plug has one  
blade wider than the other. As a safety feature, this plug fits into the  
power outlet one way only. If you cannot insert the plug completely into  
the outlet, try reversing the plug. If the plug continues to not fit, contact  
your electrician to replace the plug.  
Do not place objects on the power cord. Do not locate the product where  
persons can walk on the plug.  
Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords, as fire or electrical  
shock can result.  
Never push objects of any kind into the product through the cabinet slots.  
The objects can come in contact with dangerous voltage points. Also,  
parts can short out, causing the risk of fire or electrical shock. Never spill  
liquid of any kind on to the product.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not disassemble a telephone  
product.  
Remove the telephone plug from the wall outlet and refer servicing to  
qualified personnel under the following conditions:  
— If the power supply cord or plug is damaged or worn  
— If liquid has spilled into the telephone  
— If the telephone has been exposed to rain or water  
— If the telephone has been dropped or the cabinet damaged  
— If the product shows a distinct change in performance  
— If the telephone does not function correctly under normal operating  
conditions  
Avoid using a telephone (except a type without a cord) during an  
electrical storm. There can be a remote risk of electric shock from  
lightning.  
Do not use the telephone to report a gas leak in the area of the leak.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 104 of 332  
Chapter 7 — Important safety instructions  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
114  
Page 105 of 332  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini  
against earthquakes  
Option 11C Mini system against earthquakes. This method does not  
guarantee that the system will continue to operate during or after an  
earthquake.  
This chapter contains the following procedure:  
Procedure 1: “Earthquake bracing method” on page 105  
CAUTION  
To brace your Option 11C Mini system against earthquakes, you must  
install the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a vertical position.  
Method for earthquake bracing  
To earthquake brace your Option 11C Mini system, fasten a 3/4 in. (20 mm)  
piece of plywood securely to the wall. Then, place the system components on  
the backboard. Do not attach the system components directly to the wall.  
Procedure 1  
1
Determine the size of the backboard.  
You need a backboard that is large enough to hold all of the  
components that you will install on the wall. To determine the  
backboard size, refer to the wall plan that you developed using the  
guidelines in “Earthquake bracing requirements for chassis installed  
on a wall in a vertical position” on page 46. If you have not developed  
a wall plan, please develop one now.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Page 106 of 332  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes  
When you have determined the required backboard size, make sure  
the measurements are within the limits listed in Table 21.  
Table 21  
Backboard size limits  
Backboard size  
Minimum  
Maximum  
2 ft by 6 ft (600 mm by 1800 mm)  
4 ft by 8 ft (1200 mm by 2400 mm)  
2
Determine fastener requirements  
You need the following information to determine fastener  
requirements:  
What fasteners you must use.  
How deeply you must embed the fasteners into the wall.  
The vertical distance between fasteners.  
The horizontal distance between fasteners.  
For wood and metal stud walls, determine this spacing by the  
spacing between wall studs. Wall stud spacing must be within  
the range listed in Table 22.  
Table 22  
Stud spacing  
Stud spacing  
Minimum  
Maximum  
16 in. (400 mm)  
24 in. (600 mm)  
The required wall stud sizes for wood and metal stud walls  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes Page 107 of 332  
Table 23 provides the hardware recommendations for earthquake bracing.  
Table 23  
Hardware recommendations  
Minimum depth  
fasteners must  
be embedded in  
the wall  
Suggested  
screw  
length  
Vertical spacing  
between fasteners  
Type of wall Fastener  
Wood stud  
Metal stud  
#10 Wood Screws 16 in. (400 mm) on center 1 in. (25 mm)  
2 in. (50 mm)  
#14 Sheet Metal 16 in. (400 mm) on center  
Screws  
1.5 in. (37.5  
mm)  
Concrete  
Masonry  
1/4 in. (6 mm) Hilti 24 in. (600 mm) on center 1 1/8 in. (28 mm) 2 in. (50 mm)  
KB-II  
1/4 in. (6 mm)  
Ramset Redhead  
Dynabolt Sleeve  
Anchor  
24 in. (600 mm) on center  
2 in. (50 mm)  
Table 24 lists the maximum sizes of wall studs with a 16-inch spacing.  
Table 24  
Maximum wall stud sizes — 16 inch spacing  
Wall Studs  
Maximum Height of wall  
Wood Studs  
2 X 4 (DF #2)  
11 ft (3300 mm)  
19 ft (5700 mm)  
2 X 6 (DF #2)  
Metal Studs  
2 1/2 X 20 Gauge  
2 1/2 X 16 Gauge  
2 1/2 X 14 Gauge  
9 ft (2700 mm)  
10 ft (3000 mm)  
11 ft (3300 mm)  
3 5/8 X 20 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 18 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 16 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 14 Gauge  
12 ft (3600 mm)  
13 ft (3900 mm)  
14 ft (4200 mm)  
16 ft (4800 mm)  
4 X 20 Gauge  
4 X 18 Gauge  
14 ft (4200 mm)  
15 ft (4500 mm)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 108 of 332  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes  
Table 24  
Maximum wall stud sizes — 16 inch spacing (Continued)  
4 X 16 Gauge  
4 X 14 Gauge  
16 ft (4800 mm)  
17 ft (5100 mm)  
6 X 18 Gauge  
20 ft (6000 mm)  
Table 25 lists the maximum sizes of wall studs with a 24-inch spacing.  
Table 25  
Maximum wall stud sizes - 24 inch spacing  
Wall Studs  
Maximum Height of wall  
Wood Studs  
2 X 4 (DF #2)  
10 ft (3000 mm)  
17 ft (5100 mm)  
2 X 6 (DF #2)  
Metal Studs  
2 1/2 X 20 Gauge  
2 1/2 X 18 Gauge  
2 1/2 X 14 Gauge  
8 ft (2400 mm)  
9 ft (2700 mm)  
10 ft (3000 mm)  
3 5/8 X 20 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 18 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 16 Gauge  
3 5/8 X 14 Gauge  
11 ft (3300 mm)  
12 ft (3600 mm)  
13 ft (3900 mm)  
15 ft (4500 mm)  
4 X 20 Gauge  
4 X 18 Gauge  
4 X 16 Gauge  
4 X 14 Gauge  
12 ft (3600 mm)  
13 ft (3900 mm)  
14 ft (4200 mm)  
16 ft (4800 mm)  
6 X 18 Gauge  
18 ft (5400 mm)  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes Page 109 of 332  
3
Determine where to place the fasteners  
Refer to Figures 19 through 21 if you need help with where to place the  
fasteners on the backboard. In each figure, the minimum (2 ft by 6 ft)  
and maximum (4 ft by 8 ft) sizes of the backboard are used as  
examples.  
Figure 19 on page 110 provides the fastener locations for  
wood and metal stud walls with the minimum acceptable stud  
spacing of 16 in. (400 mm).  
Figure 20 on page 111 provides the fastener locations for  
wood and metal stud walls with the maximum acceptable stud  
spacing of 24 in. (600 mm).  
Figure 21 on page 112 provides the fastener locations for  
concrete and masonry walls.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 110 of 332  
Figure 19  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes  
Plywood fastener locations for wood and metal stud walls — 16 inch spacing  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
2 ft. by 6 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
4 ft. by 8 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
16 in.  
16 in.  
16 in.  
16 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
Fasteners  
Fasteners  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
Wall Studs  
Wall Studs  
553-8336.EPS  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes Page 111 of 332  
Figure 20  
Plywood fastener locations for wood and metal stud walls — 24 inch spacing  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
2 ft. by 6 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
4 ft. by 8 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
Fasteners  
Fasteners  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
12 in.  
Wall Studs  
Wall Studs  
553-8337  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 112 of 332  
Figure 21  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes  
Plywood fastener locations for concrete and masonry walls  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
2 ft. by 6 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
3/4 in. plywood, measuring  
4 ft. by 8 ft.  
(minimum backboard size)  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
Fasteners  
Fasteners  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
24 in.  
553-8338  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes Page 113 of 332  
4
Continue with Option 11C Mini system installation  
Now that you have securely fastened the backboard to the wall, you  
can continue with the Option 11C Mini system Installation.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 114 of 332  
Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini against earthquakes  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
134  
Page 115 of 332  
methods:  
Procedure 2: “Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a  
vertical position” on page 118  
horizontal position” on page 123  
Procedure 5: “Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis in a 19 inch  
rack/cabinet” on page 131  
This chapter also provides guidelines on how to position system components.  
See Figures 22, 26, 30, and 32. Also refer to “Chapter 4 — Creating an  
equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan” on page 69 for  
additional information.  
CAUTION  
If the Option 11C Mini chassis requires earthquake bracing, you must  
install the chassis on a wall in a vertical position. Refer to “Earthquake  
bracing requirements for chassis installed on a wall in a vertical  
position” on page 46 and “Chapter 8 — Bracing the Option 11C Mini  
against earthquakes” on page 105.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 116 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
WARNING  
An Option 11C Mini chassis is 30 lb. (13.5 kg) with circuit cards  
installed. An Option 11C Mini chassis is 26 lb. (12 kg) without circuit  
cards installed. Get help lifting the chassis if necessary.  
Installing the chassis on a wall in a vertical position  
Items required  
To install the chassis on a wall in a vertical position, you require the following  
items:  
equipment layout plan  
chassis bracket  
wall bracket  
five 1 in. #12 wood screws provided in the bracket kit (or other  
appropriate fasteners) to hold the wall brackets and chassis on the wall  
four #8 - 32 machine screws, used to attach the chassis brackets to the  
wall  
one 3/4 in. (20 mm) piece of plywood fastened to the wall  
The NTTK08 bracket kit contains all of the above items, with the exception  
of the equipment layout plan and the plywood.  
CAUTION  
An Option 11C Mini chassis is 30 lb. (13.5 kg) with circuit cards  
installed. Make sure that you fasten the equipment securely to the wall.  
Use fasteners designed to hold securely to the type of surface that will  
support the equipment. When using 3/4 in. (20 mm) plywood, or other  
similar material as a backboard, make sure to attach the backboard  
directly to the wall studs in a minimum of six locations.  
Refer to Figure 22 on page 117 for guidelines on how to position the system  
components.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 117 of 332  
Figure 22  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a wall in a vertical position  
Leave at least  
12 in. (305 mm)  
between edge  
of backboard  
and corner of  
room to allow for  
card insertion  
Allow 24 in. (610 mm) at the top  
for miscellaneous equipment  
Draw horizontal  
line for bottom  
hole of wall mount  
bracket  
Main  
Chassis  
Spacing is  
21 in. (530 mm)  
Distance from edge of  
backboard to  
isolated ground outlet  
0 - 27 in. (686 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
12 in. (305 mm)  
10 inches  
(254 mm)  
Each chassis measures  
8.4 in. x 17.2 in. x 12.8 in.  
(213 mm x 437 mm x 325 mm)  
Recommended lowest position  
for chassis installation is  
10 inches (254 mm) from floor  
553-9035  
Note: Leave space for the cross-connect terminal.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 118 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Procedure 2  
Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a vertical position  
1
Draw the vertical center line of the chassis on the plywood  
backboard.  
Allow for clearance on the left and right of the chassis for cables and  
card access. Refer to Figure 22 on page 117.  
2
Draw a horizontal line on the plywood backboard.  
This line indicates the vertical position of the lower hole of the wall  
bracket.  
Place the wall bracket against the plywood backboard. Place the lower  
mounting hole over the intersection of the vertical and horizontal lines.  
Fasten the wall bracket securely to the plywood backboard with three  
#12 wood screws provided (or other appropriate fasteners). See  
Figure 23.  
Note: Make sure that the hook feature on the wall bracket points  
toward the top of the backboard.  
Figure 23  
Wall bracket fastened to backboard  
Hook  
feature  
Lower  
mounting  
hole  
Wall  
bracket  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 119 of 332  
3
Fasten the chassis bracket to the back of the chassis using the  
four #8-32 machine screws supplied with the bracket kit. See  
Figure 24.  
Note: Make sure that the slot feature on the chassis bracket is at the  
top of the chassis. Also, the two tabs on the chassis bracket must  
extend past the bottom of the chassis.  
Figure 24  
Chassis bracket installed on the back of the chassis  
Tabs  
Slot feature.  
The hook feature on  
the wall bracket fits  
into this slot.  
4
5
Lift the chassis into place so that the slot on the chassis bracket  
engages the hook feature on the wall bracket.  
Carefully lower the chassis until the hook on the wall bracket fits  
securely into the slot on the chassis bracket.  
Fasten the chassis in position.  
Fasten the tabs, that extend past the bottom of the chassis, to the  
plywood backboard. Use the two remaining #12 wood screws from the  
bracket kit to fasten the tabs to the backboard. See Figure 25.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 120 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Figure 25  
Chassis on a wall in a vertical position  
Tabs fastened  
to plywood  
6
If you want to install a Chassis Expander, repeat the above steps.  
Refer to the equipment layout plan for the measurements and where  
to place the Chassis Expander.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 121 of 332  
Installing the chassis on a wall in a horizontal position  
Items required  
To install the chassis on a wall in a horizontal position, you require the  
following items:  
equipment layout plan  
one left shelf bracket  
one right shelf bracket  
eight 1 in. #12 wood screws supplied in the bracket kit (or other  
appropriate fasteners) to fasten the wall shelf brackets to the wall  
one 3/4 in. (20 mm.) piece of plywood fastened to the wall  
The NTTK11 bracket kit contains all of the above items, with the exception  
of the equipment layout plan and the plywood.  
CAUTION  
An Option 11C Mini chassis is 30 lb. (13.5 kg) with circuit cards  
installed. Make sure that you fasten the equipment securely to the wall.  
Use fasteners, designed to hold securely to the type of surface that will  
support the equipment. When using 3/4 in. (20 mm) plywood, or other  
similar material as a backboard, make sure you attach it directly to the  
wall studs in a minimum of six places.  
Refer to Figure 26 on page 122 for guidelines on how to position system  
components.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 122 of 332  
Figure 26  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a wall in a horizontal position  
Allow 24 in. (610 mm) at the top  
for miscellaneous equipment  
Leave at least  
2 in. (51 mm)  
between edge  
of backboard  
and corner of room  
Draw 2 vertical lines  
18.5 in. (470 mm)apart  
Draw horizontal line  
for bottom hole of  
ear bracket  
Distance from  
edge of backboard  
to isolated  
ground outlet  
0 - 27 in. (686 mm)  
S
K
R
O
W
T
Main  
Chassis  
NE  
Maximum of  
21 in. (533 mm)  
Minimum of  
12 in. (305 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
12 in. (305 mm)  
10 in. (254 mm)  
Each chassis measures  
8.4 in. x 17.2 in. x 12.8 in.  
(213 mm x 437 mm x 325 mm)  
Recommended lowest position  
for chassis installation is  
10 in. (254 mm) from floor  
553-9034  
Note: Leave space for the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 123 of 332  
Procedure 3  
Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a wall in a horizontal position  
1
2
3
Draw two vertical lines 18.5 inches apart on the plywood  
backboard.  
Allow for clearance on the left and right of the chassis for cables and  
air flow. Refer to the equipment layout plan for measurements.  
Draw a horizontal line on the plywood backboard.  
This line indicates the vertical position of the bottom hole on the  
horizontal wall shelf bracket. Refer to the equipment layout plan for  
measurements.  
Place the left shelf bracket against the plywood backboard. Place  
the lower mounting hole over the intersection of the left vertical  
line and the horizontal line.  
Fasten the shelf bracket securely to the plywood backboard. Use four  
#12 wood screws provided in the bracket kit (or other appropriate  
fasteners) to fasten the shelf bracket to the backboard.  
Note: Position the shelf bracket so that the two thumb screws, located  
on the bottom of the bracket, face downward. Leave the screws slightly  
loose, so you can adjust the brackets to the width of the chassis if  
4
Place the right shelf bracket against the plywood backboard.  
Place the lower mounting hole over the intersection of the right  
vertical line and the horizontal line. Fasten the shelf bracket  
securely to the plywood backboard with the remaining four #12 wood  
screws provided in the bracket kit (or other appropriate fasteners). See  
Figure 27.  
Note: Make sure the shelf bracket is oriented with the two thumb  
screws, located on the bottom face of the bracket, facing downwards.  
Leave the screws slightly loose, so you can adjust the brackets to the  
width of the chassis if necessary.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 124 of 332  
Figure 27  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Thumb screws on the wall shelf brackets  
Thumb screws for  
fastening the  
chassis to the  
shelf brackets  
Lower  
mounting  
hole  
5
Place the chassis on the shelf brackets.  
Carefully slide the chassis on the wall shelf brackets until it touches the  
chassis stops on the brackets. See Figure 28.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 125 of 332  
Figure 28  
Chassis stops on the wall shelf brackets  
Chassis  
stops  
6
7
Fasten the chassis in position using the four thumb screws,  
located on the bottom side of the shelf brackets.  
Tighten the eight #12 wood screws into the plywood backboard.  
Make sure that the shelf brackets and chassis are fastened  
securely in position. See Figure 29.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 126 of 332  
Figure 29  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Chassis installed on a wall in a horizontal position  
8
If you want to install a Chassis Expander on a wall in a horizontal  
position, repeat the above steps for the Chassis Expander.  
Refer to the equipment layout plan for the measurements and where  
to position the Chassis Expander.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Installing the chassis on a table  
Items required  
To install the chassis on a table, you require the following items:  
equipment layout plan  
four rubber feet  
four #8-32 machine screws  
The NTTK10 kit contains all of the above items, with the exception of the  
equipment layout plan.  
Refer to Figure 30 for guidelines on how to position system components.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 127 of 332  
Figure 30  
Typical layout for installing the chassis on a table  
Air inlets and exhausts on chassis  
clear of obstructions  
Main  
Chassis  
S
K
R
O
TW  
E
N
S
K
R
Chassis  
Expander  
O
W
T
NE  
12 in. (305 mm)  
553-9029  
Note: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 128 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Procedure 4  
Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis on a table  
1
2
Place the chassis upside down on a horizontal work surface.  
Fasten the four rubber feet securely to the bottom of the chassis  
using the machine screws. See Figure 31.  
Figure 31  
Chassis with rubber feet installed  
Rubber  
feet  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 129 of 332  
3
4
Place the chassis right side up on the rubber feet.  
Position the chassis so that the air inlets and exhausts are free  
from any obstructions. Also, you must have access to the front of  
the chassis.  
CAUTION  
Do not place the chassis on the floor. The inlets can take in dust that  
can cause harm to the system.  
5
If you want to add a Chassis Expander, follow the above steps to  
place the rubber feet on the Chassis Expander.  
Note: You can place the Main Chassis directly on top of the Chassis  
Expander. Refer to the equipment layout plan.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Installing the chassis in a 19 inch rack/cabinet  
Items required  
To install the chassis in a 19 inch rack/cabinet, you require the following  
items:  
equipment layout plan  
one left chassis guide bracket  
one right chassis guide bracket  
one left ear bracket  
one right ear bracket  
eight #12-24 self-tapping screws  
four #8-32 machine screws  
The NTTK09 contains all of the above items, with the exception of the  
equipment layout plan.  
Note: The Option 11C Mini system does not include the 19 inch  
rack/cabinet.  
Refer to Figure 32 on page 130 for guidelines on how to position system  
components.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 130 of 332  
Figure 32  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Typical layout for installing the chassis in a rack/cabinet  
Space for  
additional data  
communications  
equipment  
Main  
Chassis  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
Maximum  
of 21 in.  
(533 mm)  
Minimum  
of 8.75 in.  
(222 mm)  
Chassis  
Expander  
S
K
R
O
W
T
NE  
Isolated  
ground outlet  
Space for  
12 in. (305 mm)  
additional data  
communications  
equipment  
553-9036  
Recommended lowest  
position for chassis  
installation is 1.75 in. (44 mm)  
from bottom of rack  
Note 1: Leave wall space for the cross-connect terminal.  
Note 2: The rack/cabinet does not have to be right against the wall. You  
can position the rack/cabinet so that you have access to both the front and  
back.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 131 of 332  
Procedure 5  
Installing the Option 11C Mini chassis in a 19 inch rack/cabinet  
1
Fasten the left chassis guide bracket to the left rack/cabinet  
support. Insert two #12-24 self-tapping screws into the two middle  
slots in the chassis guide bracket and into the respective holes in the  
left rack/cabinet support. Fasten the screws.  
Note: The rack/cabinet brackets help guide the chassis into place,  
and allow one person to install the chassis in the rack/cabinet.  
2
Fasten the right chassis guide bracket to the right rack/cabinet  
support. Insert two #12-24 self-tapping screws into the two middle  
slots in the bracket and into the respective holes in the right  
rack/cabinet support. Fasten the screws. See Figure 33.  
Figure 33  
Chassis guide bracket installed in a rack  
Use two self-  
tapping screws  
in the two  
middle slots.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 132 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
3
Attach the left ear bracket (marked with an “L”) to the holes on the  
left side of the chassis (near the front).  
Use two #8-32 machine screws. Position the ear bracket so that the  
four holes on the bracket flange are nearer to the back of the chassis.  
To determine the front of the bracket, locate the “L”. This “L” must be  
at the top of the bracket and must face to the front of the chassis.  
4
Attach the right ear bracket (marked with an “R”) to the holes on  
the right side of the chassis.  
Use two #8-32 machine screws. Position the ear bracket so that the  
four holes on the bracket flange are nearer to the back of the chassis.  
To determine the front of the bracket, locate the “R”. This “R” must be  
at the top of the bracket and must face to the front of the chassis. See  
Figure 34.  
Figure 34  
Right ear bracket installed on the chassis  
Bracket flange marked  
with an “R”. Attach this  
ear bracket to the right-  
hand side of the  
chassis.  
Attach the  
ear bracket to  
these holes.  
5
Place the chassis on the chassis guide brackets.  
Carefully slide the chassis into the rack/cabinet until the ear brackets  
come to rest against the rack/cabinet support.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis Page 133 of 332  
6
Use the four remaining #12-24 self-tapping screws to fasten the  
chassis to the rack/cabinet supports (two screws on each side).  
Make sure that the back of the chassis is on the chassis guide  
brackets. See Figure 35  
Figure 35  
Chassis installed in a rack/cabinet  
Use two  
screws on  
Room for  
each side to  
fasten chassis  
to rack/cabinet  
additional data  
communications  
equipment  
7
If you want to add a Chassis Expander, follow the above steps.  
You only need to leave a small space between the Main Chassis and  
the Chassis Expander. The air circulates from the side of the chassis.  
To install the Chassis Expander, start in the next 5u pattern of  
mounting holes. This results in the Chassis Expander being  
approximately 1/4 inch from the first chassis.  
Note: In the 5u pattern, a “u” is equal to 1.75 in. and includes three  
holes spaced at 5/8 in. + 5/8 in. + 1/2 in.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 134 of 332  
Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis  
Note: In addition to more Option 11C Mini chassis, you can install  
other Data Communications Equipment in a rack/cabinet with the  
Option 11C Mini. Refer to “Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in  
a rack/cabinet” on page 144 for grounding instructions for multiple  
pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
138  
Page 135 of 332  
Expander to the Main Chassis  
This chapter describes how to add a Chassis Expander to your Option 11C  
Mini system. Use the same methods described in “Chapter 9 — Installing the  
Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot assignment plan” on  
page 69 for measurements and distances between the Main Chassis and the  
Chassis Expander.  
This chapter contains the following procedure:  
Procedure 6: “Adding a Chassis Expander” on page 135  
The Chassis Expander connects to the Main Chassis by two copper cables:  
connectivity to slot 10 only.  
Procedure 6  
Adding a Chassis Expander  
1
Install the Chassis Expander following the procedures in  
“Chapter 9 — Installing the chassis” on page 115.  
2
Connect one of the NTDK95 cables from the CE-MUX connector  
on the back of the Main Chassis to the CE-MUX connector on the  
back of the Chassis Expander.  
3
4
Tighten the screws on the connectors.  
Connect the other NTDK95 cable from the DS-30X connector on  
the back of the Main Chassis to the DS-30X connector on the back  
of the Chassis Expander.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 136 of 332  
Chapter 10 — Connecting the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis  
5
Tighten the screws on the connectors.  
Note: The expansion cable kit (NTDK89) contains two NTDK95  
cables.  
Figure 36 shows the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander connected  
with the two NTDK95 cables.  
Figure 36  
The Main and Expander chassis connected with the two NTDK95  
CE-MUX/DS-30X bus cables  
CE-MUX  
DS-30X  
connection  
connection  
6
7
Install the system ground as described in “Chapter 11 – Installing  
the system ground” on page 139.  
Add circuit cards as described in “Chapter 12 — Installing the  
circuit cards” on page 147.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 10 — Connecting the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis Page 137 of 332  
8
Follow the procedures for starting the Option 11C Mini in  
“Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing  
software” on page 209.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 138 of 332  
Chapter 10 — Connecting the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
146  
Page 139 of 332  
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground  
This chapter describes how to ground the Option 11C Mini chassis. This  
chapter contains the following procedures:  
Procedure 7: “Grounding the Option 11C Mini chassis” on page 141  
Procedure 8: “UK grounding procedure for the Option 11C Mini  
chassis” on page 144  
This chapter also describes how to ground multiple pieces of equipment in a  
rack/cabinet when one or more pieces of equipment does not have a  
grounding lug. See “Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in a  
rack/cabinet” on page 144.  
Refer to the “Grounding requirements” on page 47 for additional  
information.  
WARNING  
Correct grounding is very important. Failure to complete the  
grounding procedures may result in a system that is unsafe for the  
personnel using the equipment. If your system is not grounded  
correctly, it may not be protected from lighting or power surges, and it  
may be subject to service interruptions.  
You must use insulated ground wire for system grounding.  
Chassis powered by the same service panel  
For each Main Chassis, connect a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) ground  
wire from the Main Chassis to an NTBK80 grounding block. Connect the  
grounding block to a ground source (the ground bus in the AC service panel).  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 140 of 332  
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground  
Consider the Main Chassis and the Chassis Expander as the same ground.  
Jumper the ground wire from the Chassis Expander to the Main Chassis.  
Then, connect the ground wire from the Main Chassis to the grounding block.  
See Table 26 for region-specific grounding requirements.  
Chassis powered by different service panels  
For each Main Chassis, connect a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) ground  
wire from the Main Chassis to an NTBK80 grounding block. If any chassis  
cannot be powered from the same service panel, ground it separately from the  
other chassis back to the service panel that supplies it. All Main Chassis and  
Chassis Expander pairs must be powered from the same service panel.  
See Table 26 for region-specific grounding requirements.  
Table 26  
Region-specific grounding wire requirements  
Region  
Grounding wire requirements  
2
Germany  
#8 AWG (10 mm ) green/yellow wire  
2
Other regions in Europe  
not smaller than #6 AWG (16 mm ) at any  
point  
UK  
two green/yellow wires no thinner than  
two 10 mm  
2
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground Page 141 of 332  
Chassis grounding instructions  
Procedure 7 describes how to ground the Option 11C Mini Main Chassis and  
Chassis Expander. Repeat the steps for each Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander installed in the system.  
Procedure 7  
Grounding the Option 11C Mini chassis  
1
Make sure that you disconnect the AC power cord from the power  
outlet.  
Note: For rack/cabinet configurations, equipment must be powered  
from the same service panel.  
WARNING  
Never connect power to a chassis that is not grounded correctly.  
2
Install an NTBK80 grounding block near the chassis. See  
Figure 37.  
Note: Use the grounding block as a bridging point for ground wires  
from up to six nearby Option 11C Mini Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander pairs. If you have additional chassis, you require additional  
grounding blocks.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 142 of 332  
Figure 37  
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground  
NTBK80 ground block  
To ground lug in  
chassis  
To ground source  
3
4
Consider each Main Chassis and Chassis Expander pair as one  
ground. Jumper the Chassis Expander ground to the Main  
Chassis ground. See Figure 38.  
Install a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) ground wire from the  
ground lug on the back of the Main Chassis to the NTBK80  
grounding block. See Figure 38.  
Place a DO NOT DISCONNECT tag on the ground wire.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground Page 143 of 332  
Figure 38  
Grounding a Main Chassis and Chassis Expander pair  
Grounding lug  
on Main Chassis  
Ground  
wire to the  
grounding  
block  
Grounding lug  
on Chassis  
Expander  
5
Connect the grounding block to the ground bus in the AC power  
service panel, using #6 AWG wire. See Table 26 on page 140 for  
region-specific grounding requirements.  
WARNING  
A qualified technician or electrician must make the connection in the  
AC power service panel.  
6
7
Place a DO NOT DISCONNECT tag on the ground wire at the  
service panel.  
Test the ground.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 144 of 332  
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground  
Procedure 8  
UK grounding procedure for the Option 11C Mini chassis  
1
2
3
Connect a protective and functional ground wire from the  
grounding strip on the Krone Test Jack Frame to the ground at  
the building entry point.  
2
Use a green/yellow wire no thinner than 10 mm .  
In each chassis, connect a ground wire from the ground lug in the  
chassis to the ground connection at the Test Jack Frame.  
2
Use a green/yellow wire no thinner than 10 mm . Place a DO NOT  
DISCONNECT tag on the grounding wire.  
Measure the resistance of the ground between the Krone Test  
Jack Frame and the Main Chassis frame ground.  
3/4  
The resistance must not be more than 0.25 at 30 amperes.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in a rack/cabinet  
For multiple pieces of equipment installed in a rack/cabinet, make a separate  
ground connection from each piece of equipment to the NTBK80 grounding  
block. Consider each Main Chassis and Chassis Expander pair, however, as  
one ground. Jumper the Chassis Expander ground to the Main Chassis  
ground. See Figure 39.  
If a piece of Data Communications Equipment installed in a rack/cabinet does  
not have a grounding lug, ground the rack to the NTBK80 grounding block.  
See Figure 39.  
When you ground the rack to the grounding block, the equipment is grounded  
using the Single Point Grounding method, as shown in Figure 6 on page 52.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground Page 145 of 332  
Figure 39  
Grounding multiple pieces of equipment in a rack  
Main  
Chassis  
Chassis  
Expander  
Grounding lug on  
back of chassis  
Other data  
communications  
equipment  
without  
grounding lug  
Other data  
communications  
equipment with  
grounding lug  
Rack  
grounding  
block  
NTBK80 grounding block  
553-9027  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 146 of 332  
Chapter 11 – Installing the system ground  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
168  
Page 147 of 332  
This chapter describes how and where to install circuit cards used in the  
Option 11C Mini system. This chapter is divided into the following main  
sections:  
“Circuit cards required for the Option 11C Mini” on page 151. This  
NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card. These cards are required for the  
Option 11C Mini system. The following procedures describe how to  
install the NTDK97 and the NTDK16:  
— Procedure 9: “NTDK97 MSC installation” on page 153  
— Procedure 10: “NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card installation” on  
page 156  
“Optional circuit cards” on page 156. This section describes the circuit  
cards that are optional to the Option 11C Mini system.  
Refer to “Card slot assignments” on page 77 for additional information on  
where to place circuit cards.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 148 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Refer to the Intelligent Peripheral Equipment Circuit Card Supplements for  
full descriptions of country-specific IPE cards and their installation  
procedures.  
CAUTION  
Always handle circuit cards with caution to avoid damage caused by  
static electricity. Always store circuit cards that are not in use in an  
antistatic bag or the original packaging  
Wear an antistatic wrist strap, such as the one shown in Figure 40,  
when handling circuit cards. Static electricity can damage circuit card  
components.  
Figure 40  
Antistatic wrist strap  
Antistatic  
wrist strap  
Figure 41 on page 149 and Figure 42 on page 150 show the circuit card  
assignments for the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander. Follow these  
diagrams to make sure that you have all circuit cards inserted in the correct  
slots.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 149 of 332  
Figure 41  
Circuit card assignments in the Main Chassis  
Main Chassis  
LC  
T
48 D  
SLO  
4
T
LO  
3
S
T
SLO  
2
T
SLO  
1
Slots 4, 5, 6  
NTDK16 48-port  
DLC ONLY  
T
SLO  
0
C
PU  
Slot 3 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 2 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 1 - Any IPE or CE card  
Slot 0 - NTDK97 MSC  
553-9025  
Note 1: See Table 18 on page 78 for the cards that you can insert in the  
Main Chassis.  
Note 2: Slot 4 accepts the NTDK16 48-port DLC card only. However,  
you can place a double-width card in slot 3 and it can overlap into slot 4.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 150 of 332  
Figure 42  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Circuit card assignments in the Chassis Expander  
Chassis Expander  
T
O
L
1
S
0
T
O
L
L
L
S
S
S
9
T
O
8
T
O
7
Slot 10 - Meridian Mail  
Mini or any IPE card  
Slot 9 - Any IPE card  
Slot 8 - Any IPE card  
Slot 7 - Any IPE card  
553-9032  
Note 1: See Table 18 on page 78 for the cards that you can insert in the  
Chassis Expander.  
Note 2: To configure Meridian Mail Mini, you must place the Meridian  
Mail card in slot 10 of the Chassis Expander. The size of Slot 10 is  
double that of the other slots in the chassis. Slot 10 supports Meridian  
Mail and other application cards that require a double slot.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 151 of 332  
Circuit cards required for the Option 11C Mini  
If a circuit card has a symbol of a switch on its faceplate, it is equipped with  
option switches, strapping plugs, or both. Make sure that the circuit cards with  
option switches or strapping plugs are set correctly. Some circuit cards can  
have daughterboards and other add-on devices installed on them.  
The Option 11C Mini system supports the circuit cards described in this  
section. You can find a complete list of circuit cards requiring settings in the  
Circuit Card Installation and Testing (553-3001-211) document.  
NTDK97 Mini System Controller (MSC) card  
The NTDK97 MSC card is based on the Option 11C NTDK20 Small System  
Controller (SSC) card. Memory is integrated on the CPU. The MSC card does  
not require a separate daughterboard. The MSC card runs X11 global  
software and supports all of the NTDK20 SSC functionality with the  
following differences:  
Reduced conference capability: The MSC card provides 16 channels of  
conferencing with a maximum of six participants per conference call on  
conference loop 29. The conference capability allows for up to five  
simultaneous three-party conferences and up to two simultaneous  
six-party conferences. Conference loop 30 is disabled.  
Supports 10 logical slot addresses  
Faceplate: This card does not support fiber-optic daughterboards. The  
LEDs at the bottom of the faceplate show the Ethernet port link status  
and collision status.  
Supports one NTDK92 Chassis Expander  
You must install the MSC card in Slot 0 of the Main Chassis.  
Security Device  
The MSC card is equipped with a socket designed to hold the Security  
Device. The Security Device is shipped with each new Option 11C Mini  
system. When the MSC card is shipped, the Security Device is normally not  
attached to the socket on the MSC card. You must attach the Security Device  
to the MSC card during initial installation.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 152 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
PCMCIA interface  
The NTDK97 MSC card has a 2-slot PCMCIA interface socket located on its  
faceplate. You can insert a Software Delivery card into the socket. Use the  
Software Delivery card for software upgrades on an existing Option 11C Mini  
system. You can also use the PCMCIA socket for creating an external backup  
copy of the customer database.  
SDI ports  
The NTDK97 MSC card contains three SDI ports used to connect on-site  
terminals or remote terminals through a modem. See Table 27 for the default  
settings on the ports.  
Table 27  
SDI port default settings  
TTY Port  
Baud rate  
Data bits Stop bits  
Parity  
None  
0
Set by a DIP switch  
8
1
1
1
1
1200 (See Note below)  
1200 (See Note below)  
8
8
None  
None  
2
The baud rate shown for ports 1 and 2 is the default rate. You can configure  
Note:  
ports 1 and 2 in software to a maximum baud rate of 19200 bps.  
Ethernet interface  
The NTDK97 MSC card has a 10 Mbit ethernet port. The 15-pin connector,  
located on the back of the Main Chassis, provides external connection to the  
ethernet port. This connector is for a standard 15-pin AUI interface for a  
MAU.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 153 of 332  
Digitone Receiver, tone generation, tone detection functions  
The NTDK97 MSC card provides the following Digitone and other tone  
functions related to tone:  
30 channels of Tone and Digit Switch (TDS) and a combination of eight  
Digitone Receivers (DTR) or Dial Tone Detectors (XTD)  
Tone service ports, which can be configured as either four units of  
MFC/MFE/MFK5/MFK6/MFR or eight DTR/XTD units  
If you require additional tone receiver and transmission resources over and  
above those provided on the MSC card, install an NTAK03 TDS/DTR card.  
Procedure 9  
NTDK97 MSC installation  
1
2
Put on an antistatic wrist strap.  
Install the Security Device on the MSC card.  
Insert the Security Device in the socket on the component side of the  
MSC card. See Figure 43.  
CAUTION  
The NTDK97 MSC card has components on both sides of the circuit  
card. Be careful not to damage any of the components when you  
handle the card.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 154 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Figure 43  
MSC card with the security device installed  
Security  
Device  
Latches  
3
4
Insert the NTDK97 MSC card in the CPU slot (slot 0) of the Main  
Chassis.  
Lock the latches on the card.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 155 of 332  
NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card  
The NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card provides an interface to a maximum  
of 48 digital integrated voice and data sets. The NTDK16 Digital Line Card  
is functionally equivalent to three NT8D02 Digital Line Cards. See  
Figure 44.  
Figure 44  
48-port Digital Line Card  
Latches  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 156 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Note 1: You can only place the NTDK16 Digital Line Card in slot 4 of  
the Main Chassis.  
Note 2: The Option 11C Mini system does not require the NTDK16  
Digital Line Card to operate.  
Procedure 10  
NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card installation  
1
2
Insert the NTDK16 card in Slot 4 of the Main Chassis.  
Lock the latches on the card.  
Note 1: The NTDK16 provides three independent loops (loops 4, 5, and  
6). When the time comes to program this card in software, configure it as  
cards 4, 5, and 6 separately.  
Note 2: Three LEDs provide card status.  
Note 3: The NTDK16BA version of this card is not compatible with the  
NTDK91AA and the NTDK91AB Main Chassis.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Optional circuit cards  
NT8D14 Universal Trunk card  
The NT8D14 Universal Trunk card provides eight analog trunks which can  
function in the modes shown in Table 28.  
You can install this line card in slots 1 through 3 in the Main Chassis or slots  
7 through 10 in the Chassis Expander.  
Procedure 11  
Universal Trunk card installation  
1
Set the jumpers for the NT8D14 Universal Trunk circuit card  
according to Table 28.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 157 of 332  
Table 28  
NT8D14 Universal trunk — modes and option settings  
Jumper  
strap  
Modes  
Location  
Central (CO)  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
2-way TIE trunk (loop Dial Repeat)  
2-way TIE trunk (Outgoing Incoming  
Dial)  
Recorded Announcement (RAN)  
Paging trunk  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Japan CO/DID operation  
DID operation  
Loop length>2000 ¾  
DID operation  
J1, J2  
OFF  
Loop length <2000¾  
OFF indicates no strap present.  
Note:  
J1 and J2 locations apply to all eight trunks.  
2
Insert the card in its assigned slot.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
NT8D15 E&M Trunk card  
The E&M trunk card provides four trunks which can function as 2W E&M,  
4W E&M, and Paging.  
You can install this card in slots 1 through 3 in the Main Chassis, or in slots  
7 through 10 in the Chassis Expander.  
Procedure 12  
E&M Trunk card installation  
1
Set the switches for the NT8D15 E&M trunk circuit card according  
to Table 29.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 158 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Table 29  
NT8D15 E&M Trunk card option settings  
Mode of operation  
J2  
J9  
4W — Type 1  
4W — Type 2  
2W — Type 1  
Paging trunk  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
connect pins 2 - 3  
connect pins 2 - 3  
connect pins 2 - 3  
connect pins 2 - 3  
2
Insert the card in its assigned slot.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
NT8D02 Digital Line Card  
The NTDK16 48-port Digital Line Card is functionally equivalent to three  
NT8DO2 Digital Line Cards. However, the Option 11C Mini system also  
supports the NT8D02 Digital Line Card.  
You can install this circuit card in slots 1 to 3 of the Main Chassis or slots 7  
to 10 of the Chassis Expander.  
Procedure 13  
NT8D02 circuit card installation  
1
Insert the circuit card in slots 1 to 3 of the Main Chassis or in slots 7 to  
10 of the Chassis Expander.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
NTAK02 SDI/DCH card  
The NTDK97 MSC card includes the functionality of the NTAK02 card.  
However, if you require additional resources, you can use the NTAK02 card  
with the NTDK97 card. Before inserting the NTAK02 SDI/DCH card into its  
slot, you must set the switches and attach the jumper plugs.  
Note: Install this circuit card in the Main Chassis only.  
The NTAK02 SDI/DCH switches allow you to configure the four SDI ports  
as a combination of the following:  
SDI  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 159 of 332  
ESDI  
DCH/DPNSS  
The NTAK02 SDI/DCH card uses jumper plugs to configure the  
RS232/RS422 interfaces as one of the following:  
DTE  
DCE  
Procedure 14  
NTAK02 circuit card installation  
1
Set the switches and jumper plugs for the NTAK02 SDI/DCH card  
according to Tables 30 to 32.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 160 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Table 30  
Switch settings (Ports 0 and 1)  
Port  
0
Port  
1
SW  
1-1  
SW  
1-2  
SDI  
SDI  
DCH  
DPNSS  
ESDI  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
Table 31  
Switch settings (Ports 2 and 3)  
Port  
2
Port  
3
SW  
1-3  
SW  
1-4  
SDI  
SDI  
DCH  
DPNSS  
ESDI  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
Table 32  
Jumper settings  
Jumper  
Strap  
Strap  
Jumper  
Port  
location for DTE for DCE location  
RS422  
RS232  
Port 0  
Port 1  
J10  
C - B  
B - A  
J7  
J6  
C - B  
C - B  
B - A  
B - A  
J9  
J8  
C - B  
C - B  
B - A  
B - A  
Port 2  
Port 3  
J5  
C - B  
B - A  
J4  
J3  
C - B  
C - B  
B - A  
B - A  
J2  
J1  
C - B  
C - B  
B - A  
B - A  
2
3
Insert the card in its assigned slot.  
You can install the NTAK02 SDI/DCH card in slots 1 to 3 of the Main  
Chassis.  
Connect an NTAK19FB four port cable (or an NE-A25-B cable)  
from the corresponding connector at the back of the chassis. If  
you use an NE-A25-B cable, terminate this cable at the  
cross-connect terminal. Because the NTAK19FB cable is  
equipped with connectors, it does not require termination at the  
cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 161 of 332  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR card  
However, the TDS/DTR card can exist with the MSC card if you want to  
access additional TDS/DTR units. You must program these functions in the  
software overlays.  
Note: At times the system does not operate correctly if you install an  
NTAK03 circuit card in a slot connected to telephones. Refer to “Chapter  
13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal” on page 169  
to connect an NTAK03 circuit card to the cross-connect terminal.  
Procedure 15  
NTAK03 card installation  
1
Insert the card in its assigned slot.  
You can insert the NTAK03 TDS/DTR card into card slots 1 to 3 of the  
Main Chassis.  
2
Connect an NTAK19EC cable (or an NE-A25-B cable) from the  
corresponding connector at the back of the chassis. If you are  
using an NE-A25-B cable, terminate this cable at the  
cross-connect terminal. Because the NTAK19EC cable is  
equipped with connectors, it does have to be terminated at the  
cross-connect terminal.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 162 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
NTAG26 XMFR card  
The NTDK97 MSC card provides the functionality of the Extended  
Multi-frequency Receiver (XMFR) card. However, this card can exist with  
the MSC card if you want to access additional XMFR capability.  
The XMFR card receives MF digit information. Connections are made  
between a PBX and a CO. The Option 11C Mini supports features, such as  
Automatic Number Identification (ANI), Meridian 911 (M911), and Feature  
Group D (FGD), through the IPE MF Receiver.  
Procedure 16  
XMFR card installation  
1
Insert the NTAG26 card in its assigned slot.  
You can install the NTAG26 card in slots 1 through 3 of the Main  
Chassis or slots 7 through 10 of the Chassis Expander.  
Note: After the card is enabled, the LED flashes three times to indicate  
it is conducting a self-test. If the LED remains lit, the self-test has failed.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 163 of 332  
NT5K21 XMFC card  
The NTDK97 MSC card provides the functionality of the Extended  
Multi-frequency Compelled Sender/Receiver (XMFC) card. However, this  
card can still be used if you wish to access additional XMFC capability.  
The XMFC card provides four channels of R2 Standard signaling capability.  
Procedure 17  
XMFC card installation  
1
Insert the NT5K21 card in its assigned slot.  
You can install this card in slots 1 through 3 in the Main Chassis or  
slots 7 through 10 in the Chassis Expander.  
Note: After the card is enabled, the LED flashes three times to indicate  
it is conducting a self-test. If the LED remains lit, the self-test has failed.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 164 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
NT1R20 Off-Premise Station (OPS) analog line card  
The OPS analog line card provides eight OPS lines. You can install this card  
in slots 1 through 3 in the Main Chassis or slots 7 through 10 in the Chassis  
Expander.  
Procedure 18  
OPS analog line card installation  
1
Set the jumpers on the NT1R20 OPS card.  
Each line interface unit on the card has two jumper blocks that are  
used to select the proper loop current, depending on loop length. See  
Table 33 on page 165 and Figure 46 on page 166.  
For units connected to loops of 460 to 2300 ¾, both jumper blocks for  
that unit must have jumper straps installed. For loops that are 460 ¾  
or less, jumper straps are not installed.  
Figure 45  
Set the jumpers  
553-8346.EPS  
2
3
Insert the OPS card in its assigned slot.  
Cross connect off-premise telephones as described in  
“Connecting off-premise telephones” on page 235.  
Refer to Figure 47 on page 167 for cross connection information for the  
OPS card.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 165 of 332  
Table 33 provides OPS analog line card configuration information.  
Table 33  
OPS analog line card configuration  
Application  
On-premise station (ONS)  
Off-premise station (OPS)  
Class of service  
(Note 1)  
ONS  
OPS  
Loop resistance  
0 - 460 ohms  
0 - 2300 ohms  
Jumper strap  
setting  
(See Note 6)  
Both JX. 0 and JX.1 off  
Both JX. 0 and JX. Both JX. 0 and JX.  
1 off  
1.5-2.5  
600¾  
1 on  
2.5-3.0  
600¾  
Loop loss dB  
(See Note 3)  
0-1.5  
>1.5-2.5  
600¾  
2.5-3.0  
0-1.5  
600¾  
600¾  
4.5-15  
600¾  
TIMP  
(See Notes 1, 4)  
600¾  
600¾  
600¾  
3COM2  
No  
BIMP  
(See Notes 1, 4)  
3COM1  
3COM1 3COM2 3COM2  
Yes  
Gain treatment  
(See Note 5)  
Configured in the Single line Telephone Administration program (LD 10).  
The maximum signaling range supported by the OPS analog line card is 2300 ohms.  
Loss of untreated (no gain devices) metallic line facility. Upper loss limits correspond to loop  
Note 1:  
Note 2:  
Note 3:  
resistance ranges for 26 AWG wire.  
Default software impedance settings are:  
Note 4:  
ONS CLSOPS CLS  
TIMP: 600 ohms 600 ohms  
BIMP: 600 ohms 3COM2  
Gain treatment, such as a voice frequency repeater (VFR), is required to limit the actual OPS loop  
Note 5:  
loss to 4.5 dB, maximum. VFR treatment of metallic loops having untreated loss greater than 15dB  
(equivalent to a maximum signaling range of 2300 ohms on 26 AWG wire) is not recommended.  
Jumper strap settings JX> 0 and JX. 1 apply to all eight units; “X” indicates the unit number, 0-7.  
“OFF” indicates that a jumper strap is not installed across both pins on a jumper block. Store straps that are  
not in use on the OPS analog line card by installing them on a single jumper pin as shown in Figure 46.  
Note 6:  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 166 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
Figure 46  
OPS analog line card: jumper block locations  
Jumper block  
locations  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards Page 167 of 332  
Figure 47  
OPS analog line card cross connections  
Option 11  
Cross-Connect  
Terminal  
OPS or ONS  
Telephone  
Connections  
NT1R20  
Off-Premise  
Station  
Slot 0  
Terminal  
Block  
Line Card  
0T  
0R  
Tip  
Ring  
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
O-W  
W-G  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-S  
26  
1
Unit 0  
27  
2
Tip  
Ring  
1T  
1R  
28  
3
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
29  
4
2T  
2R  
Tip  
Ring  
30  
S-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
5
31  
6
Unit 3  
Unit 7  
Part of  
25-pair  
Cable  
553-8347.EPS  
Digital Trunk cards  
The Option 11C Mini supports the following digital trunk cards:  
NTAK09 1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI  
NTAK10 2.0 Mbit DTI  
NTAK79 2.0 Mbit PRI  
NTBK22 MISP  
NTBK50 2.0 Mbit PRI  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 168 of 332  
Chapter 12 — Installing the circuit cards  
NTRB21 1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI  
NT6D70 SILC (when used as a clock controller)  
Note: The digital trunk cards can be installed only in slots 1-3 of the  
Main Chassis.  
If you want to install digital trunk cards, refer to the following documents for  
information:  
1.5 Mbit DTI/PRI Guide (553-3011-310)  
2.0 Mbit DTI/PRI Guide (553-3011-315)  
ISDN BRI Administration and Maintenance Guide (553-3011-311)  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
184  
Page 169 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting  
the cross-connect terminal  
using the BIX, Reichle Masari (Germany), or Krone Test Jack Frame (UK)  
cross-connect terminals.  
This chapter contains the following procedures:  
Procedure 19: “Installing the BIX cross-connect terminal” on page 171  
Procedure 20: “Installing the Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal  
(Germany)” on page 172  
Procedure 21: “Installing the Krone Test Jack Frame (UK)” on page 176  
Procedure 22: “Connecting the cables” on page 179  
Note: The use of the BIX system is not mandatory; however, it is the  
recommended option.  
You can find information about the BIX cross-connect system in the  
following documents:  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Description  
(631-4511-100)  
BIX In-Building Cross-Connect System Material Installation and  
Servicing (631-4511-200)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 170 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
For information about 1.5 Mbit and 2.0 Mbit DTI/PRI-related wiring and  
cables, refer to the following documents:  
Option 11C 1.5Mbit DTI/PRI Administration and Maintenance Guide  
(553-3011-310)  
Option 11C 2.0Mbit DTI/PRI Administration and Maintenance Guide  
(553-3011-315).  
Terminal block requirements  
The cross-connect terminal requires enough connecting blocks to terminate  
the following wires:  
for the NTAK09 circuit card, use the NTBK04 cable  
for the NTAK10, NTAK79, and NTBK50 circuit cards, use the NTBK05  
cable  
up to five 25-pair cables from each chassis.  
— Each slot that is equipped with a trunk or line circuit card requires a  
cable.  
Connectors Card 1 through Card 6 on the back of the Main  
Chassis correspond to card numbers 1 through 6 in the Main  
Chassis.  
Connectors Card 7 through Card 10 on the back of the Chassis  
Expander correspond to card numbers 7 through 10 in the Chassis  
Expander.  
Allow for additional cables at the cross-connect terminal if  
initially you leave any of the slots in the chassis empty.  
— If the NTAK19EC 2-port SDI cable or the NTAK19FB 4-port SDI  
cable are not used with the NTAK03 or NTAK02 cards, then you  
require a 25-pair cable for each of these cards.  
four conductors for the AUX cable from the Main Chassis  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 171 of 332  
one 25-pair cable from each QUA6 PFTU  
wiring from telephones and trunks  
WARNING  
Always use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Do  
not install telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Never touch  
uninsulated telephone wiring, unless the line is disconnected at the  
network interface.  
Installing the BIX cross-connect terminal  
Procedure 19 describes how to install the BIX cross-connect terminal.  
Procedure 19  
Installing the BIX cross-connect terminal  
1
Refer to the equipment layout plan to determine where to place  
the cross-connect terminal.  
2
Layout the terminal blocks as shown in Figure 48 on page 172.  
For information about the BIX system, refer to BIX Installation and  
Servicing (631-4511-200).  
3
Attach labels on the cross-connect terminal to indicate the  
terminal blocks assigned to the following:  
25-pair cables from the chassis  
AUX wiring  
Power Failure Transfer Units (PFTUs)  
telephones and consoles  
trunks  
miscellaneous equipment  
Note: If you are installing the BIX cross-connect system, refer to BIX  
Installation and Servicing (631-4511-200). This document provides  
information about labels used with the BIX terminal blocks.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 172 of 332  
Figure 48  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
Typical BIX cross-connect terminal layout  
Main Chassis  
Cable Card 1  
Cable Card 2  
Cable Card 3  
Cable Card 4/6  
Cable Card 5/6  
AUX cable  
PFTU  
Telephones  
Trunks  
Chassis Expander  
and  
Miscellaneous  
Cable Card 7  
Cable Card 8  
Cable Card 9  
Cable Card 10  
553-9026  
Note: One 25-pair cable contains Card 4 and Card 6 (units 0-7). Another  
25-pair cable contains Card 5 and Card 6 (units 8-15).  
Installing the Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal  
(Germany)  
Procedure 20 describes how to install the Reichle Masari cross-connect  
terminal for Germany.  
Procedure 20  
Installing the Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal (Germany)  
1
Refer to the equipment layout plan to determine where to place  
the cross-connect terminal.  
2
Layout the terminal blocks as shown in Figure 49.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 173 of 332  
Figure 49  
Typical Reichle Masari cross-connect terminal layout (Germany)  
Card 1  
Card 10  
Card 2  
Card 10  
Card 3  
Card 4  
Card 6 (0-7)  
Card 5  
Card 5  
Card 6  
Card 6  
Card 7  
Free block for wiring  
Ground block  
Card 7  
Card 7  
Card 8  
Card 9  
553-9028  
Note: One 25-pair cable contains Card 4 and Card 6 (units 0-7). Another  
25-pair cable contains Card 5 and Card 6 (units 8-15).  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 174 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
3
Attach labels on the cross-connect terminal to indicate the  
terminal blocks assigned to the following:  
25-pair cables from the chassis  
AUX wiring  
Telephones and Attendant Consoles  
Trunks  
Analog line cards  
DC5/AC15/RAN/PAG cards  
Data Access cards  
Power Failure Transfer Units  
Digital line cards  
Exchange line trunk cards  
Direct Dialing Inward trunk cards  
miscellaneous equipment  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Installing the Krone Test Jack Frame for the UK  
The Krone Test Jack Frame provides terminating strips that hold 10 pairs of  
cable. Generally, only 8 of the 10 pairs are used. As a result, one 25-pair cable  
requires three terminating strips:  
8 pairs/strip x 3 strips = 24 pairs  
Figure 50 shows how one 25-pair cable is divided among three terminating  
strips on the Krone Test Jack Frame.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 175 of 332  
Figure 50  
25-pair cable on three Krone strips  
Pair  
Pin number  
Wire Colour  
Kron e strip  
1T  
1R  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
2T  
2R  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
3T  
3R  
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
4T  
4R  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
1
5T  
5R  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
6T  
6R  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
7T  
7R  
32  
7
R-O  
O-R  
8T  
8R  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
9T  
9R  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
10T  
10R  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
11T  
11R  
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
12T  
12R  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
2
13T  
13R  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
14T  
14R  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
15T  
15R  
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
16T  
16R  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
17T  
17R  
42  
17  
Y-O  
O-Y  
18T  
18R  
43  
18  
Y-G  
G-Y  
19T  
19R  
44  
19  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
20T  
20R  
45  
20  
Y-S  
S-Y  
21T  
21R  
46  
21  
V-BL  
BL-V  
3
22T  
22R  
47  
22  
V-O  
O-V  
23T  
23R  
48  
23  
V-G  
G-V  
24T  
24R  
49  
24  
V-BR  
BR-V  
25T  
25R  
50  
25  
V-S  
S-V  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 176 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
Procedure 21 describes how to install the Krone Test Jack Frame for the UK.  
Procedure 21  
Installing the Krone Test Jack Frame (UK)  
1
2
Refer to the equipment layout plan to determine where to place  
the cross-connect terminal.  
Layout the terminal blocks as shown in Figure 51.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 177 of 332  
Figure 51  
Typical Krone cross-connect terminal layout (UK)  
Pair  
Pair  
Spare  
24  
16  
8
17  
9
1
PFTU  
termination  
Other  
equipment  
1
6
AUX cable  
Grounding block  
17  
9
1
24  
16  
8
Attendant  
Console  
24  
16  
8
17  
9
1
Card 10  
Chassis  
Expander  
17  
9
1
24  
16  
8
Card 9  
24  
16  
8
24  
16  
8
17  
9
1
17  
9
Card 8  
Card 7  
1
16  
16  
8
Card 6 (8-15)  
Card 5  
9
9
1
8
16  
8
1
9
1
Card 6 (0-7)  
Card 4  
17  
9
1
17  
9
1
24  
16  
8
Main  
Chassis  
Card 3  
Card 2  
24  
16  
8
17  
9
24  
16  
Card 1  
1
8
553-9033  
Note: One 25-pair cable contains Card 4 and Card 6 (units 0-7). Another  
25-pair cable contains Card 5 and Card 6 (units 8-15).  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 178 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
3
Attach labels on the cross-connect terminal to indicate the terminal  
blocks assigned to the following:  
Analog line cards  
DC15/AC15/RAN/PAG cards  
Data Access cards  
AUX wiring  
Power Failure Transfer Units  
Digital line cards  
Telephones and Attendant Consoles  
Exchange line trunk cards  
Direct Dialing Inward trunk cards  
miscellaneous equipment  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Connecting the cables  
WARNING  
Always use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Do  
not install telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Never touch  
uninsulated telephone wiring unless the line is disconnected at the  
network interface.  
Each Option 11C Mini system chassis requires up to five 25-pair cables. The  
Main Chassis requires an additional terminal block at the cross-connect  
terminal to terminate the 9-pin conductor auxiliary cable.  
Connect all cables at the back of the chassis.  
Note: Use caution when using NE-A25B cables with the NTAK02, and  
NTAK03 cards. These cables are not wired out to station equipment or  
trunk circuits. Do not use the NE-A25B cable with the NTBK45,  
NTAK10, NTBK50, or NTAK79 circuit cards.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 179 of 332  
For 1.5 Mbit and 2.0 Mbit DTI/PRI-related wiring and cable information,  
refer to the following documents:  
Option 11C 1.5Mbit DTI/PRI Administration and Maintenance Guide  
(553-3011-310)  
Option 11C 2.0 Mbit DTI/PRI Administration and Maintenance Guide  
(553-3011-315) for  
Procedure 22  
Connecting the cables  
1
2
Loosen the velcro straps at each connector you plan to use.  
Connect a 25-pair cable to each of the connectors that will  
contain a line or trunk card. Refer to the card slot assignment  
plan.  
Make sure you tag both ends of each cable with the chassis and  
connector numbers. See Figure 52.  
Figure 52  
Cable connectors on the back of the Main Chassis  
Connector  
for slot 3  
Connector for  
slot 5 and half  
of slot 6  
Connector for  
slot 4 and half  
of slot 6  
Connector  
for slot 2  
Connector  
for slot 1  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 180 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
3
4
Tighten the velcro straps when you have connected each cable to  
the chassis.  
For systems required to meet CISPR-B Electromagnetic Compatibility  
(EMC), perform the following step. On each installed 25-pair cable,  
attach the supplied ferrite filter to the cable. Attach the ferrite filter as  
near the connector as possible (see Figure 53). To attach the ferrite  
filter, press the cable firmly into the groove on one side of the open  
filter. Close the filter around the cable and press the filter together  
using the fastening clip snaps close.  
Figure 53  
A ferrite filter installed on a 25-pair cable (CISPR-B EMC systems)  
25-pair cable to  
cross-connect  
terminal  
Ferrite filter  
5
6
Terminate all the 25-pair cables installed at the cross-connect  
terminal.  
Label all the cables at the cross-connect terminal blocks according to  
the card slot assignment plan.  
Install the AUX cable in the lower 9-pin connector located on the  
bottom left-hand side of the Main Chassis. See Figure 54.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 181 of 332  
Figure 54  
AUX cable connector  
AUX connector  
Terminate the AUX cable at the cross connect terminal, according to  
Table 34.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 182 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
Table 34  
AUX cable termination information  
Wire  
Color  
number  
Designation  
Connection  
W-BL  
BL-W  
O-W  
W-O  
G-W  
W-G  
1
2
3
4
5
6
BRTN  
BRTN  
to QUA6-J1 1R  
to QUA6-J1 2R  
-48V AUX (250mA) to QUA6-J1 25T, 25R  
PFTS  
to QUA6-J1 2T  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
7
For installations in Germany, complete the form shown in Figure 55 for  
each card slot.  
This form provides a record of cross connections that you will perform  
after you start the system.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal Page 183 of 332  
Figure 55  
Cross connections record  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 184 of 332  
Chapter 13 — Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
190  
Page 185 of 332  
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure  
Transfer Units  
This chapter describes how to install a QUA6 Power Failure Transfer Unit  
(PFTU). This chapter contains the following procedure:  
Procedure 23: “Installing the PFTU” on page 185  
You can connect PFTUs to the Main Chassis.  
Note: The QUA6 PFTU operates with loop start and ground start CO  
trunks. With ground start trunks, the associated telephone set must have  
a ground start button.  
If you require power failure backup as a fail safe for this system, use analog  
trunks. A PFTU does not support digital trunks.  
Installing the PFTU  
Refer to the equipment layout plan to determine where to locate the PFTU.  
See “Chapter 4 — Creating an equipment layout plan and a card slot  
assignment plan” on page 69.  
Procedure 23  
Installing the PFTU  
1
2
Install the PFTU on the wall near the system cross-connect  
terminal. Fasten the PFTU in position with four screws.  
Install an NE-A25B-type 25-pair cable from connector J1 on the  
faceplate of the PFTU to its assigned location at the  
cross-connect terminal.  
3
Label the pairs of the J1 cable on the cross-connect terminal  
block as shown in Figure 56 on page 186.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Page 186 of 332  
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure Transfer Units  
Figure 56  
J1 cable labels  
Pairs Pairs Pairs Pairs Pairs Pairs Pairs  
1 to 4 1 to 4 1 to 4 1 to 4 1 to 4 1 to 4 1 to 4  
PFT1  
Power  
Control PFT1 PFT2 PFT3 PFT4 PFT5  
BIX blocks, attach the appropriate designation strip.  
553-8342.EPS  
4
Connect the PFTU power and control connections to the AUX  
connector on the Main Chassis. See Figure 57 on page 187 and  
Table 35 on page 188.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure Transfer Units Page 187 of 332  
Figure 57  
Auxiliary connector  
AUX connector  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 188 of 332  
Table 35  
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure Transfer Units  
Control and power connections on cable J1  
J1 Cable from QUA6 (see Figure 58 on page 189)  
Pair  
Number  
Pair  
Color  
Connects  
to  
Function  
Control  
Cross-connect to  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
(ALM)  
BRTN  
Not used.  
W-BL 1-dot connection on AUX  
cable from the chassis  
2T  
W-O  
PFTS  
W-O 1-dot connection on AUX  
cable from the chassis. Transfer  
begins by applying ground to this  
lead.  
2R  
3T  
O-W  
W-G  
BRTN  
(TC)  
BL-W 1-dot connection on AUX  
cable from the chassis  
Console transfer switch. See  
console connections. Transfer  
begins by applying ground to this  
lead.  
3R  
4T  
4R  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR-W  
Not used.  
Not used.  
Not used.  
25T  
25R  
S-V  
V-S  
-48 V  
-48 V  
O-W 1-dot connection on AUX  
cable. Maximum 250 mA draw on  
O-W lead.  
PFTU  
power  
5
Connect the Attendant Console to the PFTU:  
Attendant Console 14 Tip (14T) to ground  
3 Tip (3T) of PFTU to 11 Ring (11R) of Attendant Console (power  
fail transfer switch)  
Attendant Console 11 Tip (11T) to ground  
Note: The AUX cable on the Option 11C Mini does not provide power  
to the M2250 Attendant Console. Two Digital Line Card TNs or an  
Attendant Console power supply provide power to the M2250 Attendant  
Console.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure Transfer Units Page 189 of 332  
Figure 58  
Power fail transfer  
QUA6A  
PFTU  
XFER  
W- BL- O- W- G- W-  
A
U
X
BL W W O W G  
J1  
P
F
T
U
T
1
R
1
T
2
R
2
T
3
R
3
TR 2 3 4  
PFT1  
5 5  
2 2  
V V  
NTAK1104  
553-8343.EPS  
PFTU control lead signals  
To connect PFTUs from other manufacturers, use the information provided  
in Table 36.  
Table 36  
PFTU control lead signals  
NTAK1104 AUX  
cable lead  
Lead State when PFTU is Lead State when PFTU  
in non-transferred state is in transferred state  
BRTN  
GROUND  
GROUND  
BRTN  
GROUND  
GROUND  
-48V AUX  
PFTS  
-48V DC (250 mA max.)  
OPEN  
-48V DC (250 mA max.)  
GROUND  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 190 of 332  
Chapter 14 — Installing Power Failure Transfer Units  
Note 1: Refer to Figure 57 on page 187 to see where the Auxiliary cable  
connects to the Option 11C Mini system.  
Note 2: If power is removed from the QUA6, a transfer of the PFTU can  
occur.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
208  
Page 191 of 332  
SDI and Ethernet ports  
This chapter contains modem setup requirements and the following two  
procedures for connecting communication devices to the Option 11C Mini:  
Procedure 24 “Connecting SDI ports on the MSC card” on page 193  
Procedure 25 “Setting up the terminal” on page 201  
Procedure 26 “Connecting the Ethernet cable” on page 206  
In an Option 11C Mini system, the following cards provide SDI ports:  
NTDK97 MSC card provides three SDI ports  
NTAK02 SDI/DCH card provides four ports of which up to two can be  
SDI ports  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR card provides two SDI ports  
Note: The NTDK97 MSC card includes the functionality of the  
NTAK03 card. However, you can also configure the NTAK03 card, if  
required.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 192 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
Modem setup requirements  
Modems connected to the Option 11C Mini are set as follows:  
Carrier Detect (CD): Active if carrier detected on incoming call  
Clear to Send (CTS): Normal operation or forced active  
Hardware and software: Disabled flow control  
The ports on the Option 11C Mini are disabled if devices connected to the  
ports generate additional “garbage” characters. For this reason, do not use  
modems in the following modes:  
Loopback  
Auto Echo  
Self Test  
Note: The SDI ports are designed for use with “dumb” modems.  
“Intelligent” modems can be used. Make sure that the modems do not  
enter into modes of operation that send additional characters to the  
system.  
Table 37 lists some of the problems that can be related to modems.  
Table 37  
Modem problems  
Problem  
Solution  
CDR is not printing on an ESDI port  
configured as 8 bits, no parity, and 1 stop  
bit.  
Change the modem setup to 7 bits, no parity, 1  
stop bit, or add MTC or SCH to the ESDI user  
prompt.  
Modem is not communicating with the  
Option 11C Mini when the User is MTC,  
BUG, or CTY  
Change the modem setup to 7 bits or the parity  
to EVEN/ODD.  
(The default setting of 8 bits, no parity, 1  
stop bit is incompatible with the modem).  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 193 of 332  
Installing and connecting SDI ports  
You can use a switch setting on the circuit card’s faceplate to control the baud  
rate for port 0. Make sure the baud rate and device option settings are set  
correctly.  
Note: When the time comes to configure ports 1 and 2, configure them  
in Overlay 17.  
Use Port 0 for software installation and upgrades. SDI port 0 is the only  
SDI port that you can use for software installation and upgrades.  
You can use all three ports on the MSC card to connect terminals or  
Use an NTBK48 3-port SDI cable with the MSC card.  
Note: The default baud rate of the MSC card is 1200 bps; the maximum  
data rate is 19,200 bps. When you change the DIP switch on the  
faceplate, make sure only one baud rate switch is set to ON. See  
Table 38.  
Table 38  
Default port configuration for the MSC card  
Port  
Use  
Baud rate  
Data bits  
Stop bits  
Parity  
0
1
2
MTC/SCH/BUG  
MTC/SCH/BUG  
MTC/SCHBUG  
Set by a DIP switch  
1200 (See Note 1)  
1200 (See Note 2)  
8
8
8
1
1
1
None  
None  
None  
Procedure 24 describes how to connect a terminal, modems, and other  
devices, such as CDR devices and additional TTYs, to the MSC card.  
Procedure 24  
Connecting SDI ports on the MSC card  
1
The NTBK48 3-port SDI cable has one ferrite filter attached to it.  
Connect an additional ferrite filter as close as possible to the  
9-pin connector on the NTBK48 3-port SDI cable.  
Note: The additional ferrite filter comes with the Option 11C Mini  
system.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 194 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
2
Connect the NTBK48 3-port SDI cable to the 9-pin SDI connection  
(COM RS-232) at the back of the Main Chassis. See Figures 59 and  
60.  
Figure 59  
SDI cable connection  
SDI connector  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 195 of 332  
Figure 60  
An additional ferrite filter attached to the SDI cable  
Additional ferrite  
filter  
Existing ferrite  
filter  
3
4
Connect the system terminal to the cable marked “port 0” on the  
NTBK48 3-port cable.  
You require a Modem Eliminator Adapter to connect the Option 11C  
Mini to a TTY terminal. This adapter is in included in the NTDK88 cable  
kit.  
If the system is to be accessed remotely, connect the system  
modem to the cable marked “port 1” on the NTBK48 cable.  
5
6
Connect the modem to an outside line.  
Test the modem for correct operation when the system is  
operating.  
Note: You can use the remaining ports for other equipment, such as  
CDR devices or TTYs.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 196 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
NTAK02 SDI/DCH card  
Only the Main Chassis supports the NTAK02 SDI/DCH card. You can  
configure this card to support ports for the following:  
two SDI and two DCHI  
one SDI, one DCHI, and two ESDI  
four ESDI  
You can use the NTAK02 ports to access overlay software. Define these ports  
in the configuration database as the SDI logical type.  
An NTAK19FB 4-port SDI cable is designed for use with the NTAK02  
circuit card. However, you can use an NE-A25B 25-pair cable to extend the  
connections to the cross-connect terminal. See Tables 39 through 42 for the  
connections for each port.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 197 of 332  
Table 39  
NTAK02 pinouts — Port 0 at the cross-connect terminal  
Cable  
RS232  
Designations  
(I=input/O=output)  
Signal  
Pair  
Color  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
0
DTR  
0
DCD  
-
O
-
I
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
I
I
O
O
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
O
I
I
O
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
RX  
TX  
TX  
RX  
I
O
O
I
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
-
-
-
-
-
-
SG  
SG  
Table 40  
NTAK02 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 1  
Cable  
RS422  
RS232  
Designations  
(I=input  
Designations  
(I=input  
Signal  
DTE DCE  
O=output)  
O=output)  
Signal  
DTE DCE  
Pair Color  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
SCTEA  
-
SCTA  
-
O
-
I
-
O
-
I
-
SCT  
-
SCT  
-
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
SCTEB  
DTR  
SCTB  
DCD  
O
O
I
I
-
-
-
-
CH/CI  
DTR  
-
DCD  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
SCRA  
SCTA  
SCTEA  
RXCA  
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
SCR  
SCT  
SCT  
-
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
SCRB  
SCTB  
SCTEB  
RXCB  
I
I
O
O
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
11T BK-BL  
11R BL-BK  
RXDA  
TXDA  
TXDA  
RXDA  
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
RXD  
TXD  
TXD  
RXD  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 198 of 332  
Table 40  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
NTAK02 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 1 (Continued)  
12T BK-O  
12R O-BK  
RXDB  
TXDB  
TXDB  
RXDB  
I
O
O
I
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
25T  
25R  
V-S  
S-V  
SG  
-
SG  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SG  
-
SG  
-
Table 41  
NTAK02 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 2  
Cable RS422  
RS232  
Designations  
Designations  
(I=input  
(I=input  
Signal  
DTE DCE  
O=output)  
O=output)  
Signal  
Pair  
Color  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
-
-
-
-
-
O
-
I
-
-
DTR  
DCD  
14T  
14R BR-BK  
BK-BR  
-
-
-
-
I
I
O
O
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
-
-
-
-
O
I
I
O
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
-
-
-
-
I
O
O
I
RX  
TX  
TXD  
RXD  
17T  
17R  
Y-O  
O-Y  
O
-
I
-
O
-
I
-
-
-
SG  
SG  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 199 of 332  
Table 42  
NTAK02 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 3  
Cable RS422  
RS232  
Designations  
(I=input  
Designations  
(I=input  
Signal  
DTE DCE  
O=output)  
O=output)  
Signal  
Pair  
Color  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
DTE  
DCE  
17T  
17R  
Y-O  
O-Y  
SCTEA  
-
SCTA  
-
O
-
I
-
O
-
I
-
SCT  
-
SCT  
-
18T  
18R  
Y-G  
G-Y  
SCTEB  
DTR  
SCTB  
DCD  
O
O
I
I
-
-
-
-
CH/CI  
DTR  
-
DCD  
19T  
19R  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
DSR  
DCD  
CH/CI  
DTR  
20T  
20R  
Y-S  
S-Y  
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
O
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
RTS  
CTS  
CTS  
RTS  
21T  
21R  
V-BL  
BL-V  
SCRA  
SCTA  
SCTEA  
RXCA  
I
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
SCR  
SCT  
SCT  
-
22T  
22R  
V-O  
O-V  
SCRB  
SCTB  
SCTEB  
RXCB  
I
I
O
O
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
23T  
23R  
V-G  
G-V  
RXDA  
TXDA  
TXDA  
RXDA  
I
O
O
I
I
O
O
I
RXD  
TXD  
TXD  
RXD  
24T  
24R  
V-BR  
BR-V  
RXDB  
TXDB  
TXDB  
RXDB  
I
O
O
I
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
25T  
25R  
V-S  
S-V  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SG  
-
SG  
-
SG  
SG  
NTAK03 TDS/DTR card  
The NTDK97 MSC card includes the functionality of the NTAK03  
TDS/DTR card. However, you can also configure the NTAK03 card, if  
required.  
An NTAK19EC cable is designed for use with the NTAK03 circuit card.  
However, you can use an NE-A25B 25-pair cable to extend the connections  
to the cross-connect terminal. Table 43 on page 200 and Table 44 on  
page 201 show the connections for each port.  
Use a modem eliminator to connect the RS232 converter cable and the  
NTAK19EC SDI cable to a terminal. The modem eliminator is not required  
when connecting to a modem.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 200 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
Note: A modem eliminator is supplied with the system.  
Table 43  
NTAK03 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 0  
Designations  
Pair  
Color  
Signal  
(I=input,  
O=output)  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
DSR  
DCD  
I
I
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
-
-
O
DTR  
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
RTS  
CTS  
O
I
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
RX  
TX  
I
O
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
SG  
-
O
-
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 201 of 332  
Table 44  
NTAK03 connections at the cross-connect terminal — Port 1  
Designations  
Pair  
Color  
Signal  
(I=input,  
O=output)  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
DSR  
-
I
-
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
-
-
O
DTR  
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
RTS  
CTS  
O
I
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
RX  
TX  
I
O
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
-
-
I
DCD  
22T  
22R  
V-O  
O-V  
SG  
-
O
-
Terminal setup  
The terminal can be setup any time, except during data transmission. Do not  
set up the terminal during data transmission to avoid potential data loss.  
Table 46 on page 203 and Table 48 on page 205 provide setup values. Use  
Procedure 25 to set up the terminal.  
Procedure 25  
Setting up the terminal  
1
2
Turn on the power for the terminal.  
Enter setup mode by pressing the <SETUP> key located on the  
top row of the special function keys.  
The terminal screen displays the current setup values.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Page 202 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
3
Change the value in each field on each setup screen as  
necessary.  
Use the keys listed in Table 45 to view and change setup values.  
Table 45  
Setup (keys and functions)  
Key  
Function  
Arrow key  
<Enter>  
Move from field to field  
Scroll through possible values or cause  
requested action to occur (depends on type  
of field)  
<Next Screen>  
<Prev Screen>  
Move to next setup screen  
Move back to last screen  
4
Save changes by returning to the General setup screen, moving  
the cursor to the Saved field, and pressing <Enter>.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 203 of 332  
Table 46  
HP700/32 setup values  
Global set-up screen  
Host Port  
1
Keyboard  
U.S.  
Background  
Dark  
Message Translations  
English  
Screen Saver  
Refresh Rate  
Key Click  
10 Min  
72 Hz  
Yes  
Setup Translations  
Clear Display  
Clear Comm  
English  
User Set-up Screen  
Smooth Scroll  
Cursor Type  
Cursor  
Jump scroll  
Blink Line  
Off  
Display Width  
80  
Display Width Allowed 80 or 132  
Char Cell Height  
Clr on Width Change  
Aux Mode  
16  
2nd Message Line On  
Yes  
Off  
Off  
No  
24  
Message Line  
Status Line  
On Line  
Local Echo  
Auto Wrap  
Auto Linefeed  
Display Ctrl Codes Off  
Emulation Set-up  
Emulation  
Terminal Id  
Control Codes  
Characters Mode  
Preferred Char Set DEC Supplemental  
On  
On  
Yes  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Aux to Host  
Print Terminator=FF  
Logical Page Size  
Number of Pages  
1
VT320  
Cursor Keys  
Normal  
Off  
VT220  
7-bit  
Print Scroll Region  
User Features Locked  
User Keys Locked  
Data Procession Keys  
No  
8-bit  
No  
No  
Key Pad Mode  
Port 1 Set-up  
Communications  
Data Length  
Parity  
Application  
Full Duplex  
8-bits  
None  
1
2400  
=Xmit  
Xoff  
Xoff at 128  
Limited Transmit  
DSRI  
CTS  
CD  
Break Disconnect  
Disconnect Delay  
Aux printer Type  
Off  
No  
Ignore  
Ignore  
170ms  
Never  
National  
Stop Bits  
Xmit Baud  
RecvBaud  
Xmit pace  
Recv Pace  
Port 2 Set-up  
Communications  
Data Length  
Parity  
Full Duplex  
8-bits  
None  
1
Xmit pace  
Xon/Xoff  
Xoff at 128  
Off  
Recv Pace  
Limited Transmit  
Break Duration  
Aux Printer Type  
Stop Bits  
170ms  
Xmit Baud  
RecvBaud  
9600  
National  
=Xmit  
Keyboard Set-up  
Lock Key  
Kbd Lock Enable  
Save Tabs  
Auto Repeat  
Margin Bell  
Caps Lock  
Yes  
Warning Bell  
Auto Answerback  
Answerback =  
Conceal Answerback  
Do not set any tabs or programmed keys.  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 204 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
Table 47  
VT420 setup values  
Global Set-Up  
On Line  
Sessions on Comm1  
CRT Saver  
Comm1=RS232  
Printer Shared  
70Hz  
Display Set-Up  
80 Columns  
Interpret Controls  
Auto Wrap  
No Status Display  
Cursor Steady  
3x24 pages  
Jump Scroll  
Dark Screen  
Cursor  
24 Lines/Screen  
Vertical Coupling  
Page Coupling  
Auto Resize Screen  
Block Style Cursor  
General Set-up  
VT400 Mode, 7-bit Controls  
User Defined Keys Unlocked  
User Features Unlocked  
8-bit Characters  
Normal Cursor Keys  
No New Line  
UPSS DEC Supplemental  
VT420 ID  
When Available Update  
Application Keypad  
Communications Set-Up  
Transmit=2400  
Receive=Transmit  
Xoff=64  
8bits, No Parity  
1 Stop Bit  
Disconnect, 2 s Delay  
Limited Transmit  
No Auto Answerback  
Answerback=  
Not Concealed  
No Local Echo  
Data Leads Only  
Modem High Speed = ignore  
Modem Low Speed = ignore  
Printer Set-Up  
Speed=2400  
No printer to Host  
Normal Print Mode  
XOFF  
8bits, No Parity, 1 Stop bit  
Print Full Page  
Print National Only  
No Terminator  
Keyboard Set-up  
Keyboard Set-up  
Typewriter Keys  
Caps Lock  
Local Compose  
Ignore Alt  
F1 = Hold  
Auto Repeat  
F2 = Print  
Keyclick High  
Margin Bell  
Warning Bell High  
Character Mode  
<X] Delete  
F3 = Set-Up  
F4 = Session  
F5 = Break  
,< and .> Keys  
<> Key  
‘~Key  
Tab Set-Up  
Leave this screen at the default values  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 205 of 332  
Table 48  
VT220 setup values  
Global Set-Up  
On Line  
Sessions on Comm1  
CRT Saver  
Comm1=RS232  
Printer Shared  
70Hz  
Display Set-Up  
80 Columns  
Interpret Controls  
Auto Wrap  
Jump Scroll  
Light Text, Dark Screen  
Cursor  
Block Style Cursor  
General Set-up  
VT200 Mode, 7-bit Controls  
User Defined Keys Unlocked  
User Features Unlocked  
Multinational  
Application Keypad  
Normal Cursor Keys  
No New Line  
Communications Set-Up  
Transmit=2400  
Receive=Transmit  
Xoff at 64  
8bits, No Parity  
1 Stop Bit  
No Local Echo  
Data Leads Only  
Disconnect, 2 s Delay  
Limited Transmit  
Printer Set-Up  
Speed=9600  
Normal Print Mode  
8bits, No Parity,  
1 Stop bit  
Print Full Page  
Print National Only  
No Terminator  
Keyboard Set-up  
Typewriter Keys  
Caps Lock  
Auto Repeat  
Keyclick High  
Margin Bell  
Warning Bell  
Break  
Answerback=  
Not Concealed  
Tab Set-Up Screen  
Leave this screen at the default values  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 206 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
Installing and connecting an ethernet cable  
Ethernet connection  
The Option 11C Mini system provides a 10 Mbit Ethernet connection to a  
Local Area Network (LAN). The ethernet cable connector is at the back of the  
Main Chassis on the bottom left-hand side. See Figure 61.  
Figure 61  
Ethernet connection  
Ethernet  
connector  
Procedure 26  
Connecting the Ethernet cable  
1
Insert an industry-standard Medium Access Unit (MAU) into the  
Ethernet connection at the bottom left-hand corner of the Main  
Chassis.  
Note: The Option 11C Mini system does not include the MAU.  
2
Insert the Ethernet cable into the MAU. See Figure 62.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports Page 207 of 332  
Note: When the time comes to configure the Ethernet link, use  
Overlay 117.  
Figure 62  
Ethernet cable inserted into an industry-standard MAU  
Industry-standard  
MAU  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 208 of 332  
Chapter 15 — Installing and connecting SDI and Ethernet ports  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
228  
Page 209 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C  
Mini and installing software  
This chapter describes how to start the Option 11C Mini system and to make  
Software Installation Program and how to install software in the Option 11C  
Procedure 27: “Start-up procedure for a new system installation, using  
the MSC card” on page 210  
Procedure 28: “Start-up procedure for a previously installed system” on  
page 211  
Procedure 29: “Installing software” on page 216  
Starting the Option 11C Mini  
Before you continue with the procedures described in this section, make sure  
all necessary hardware is connected to, or installed in the system. Check all  
connections, and make sure that you have installed all of the circuit cards  
correctly.  
Before you start the Option 11C Mini, complete Step 1 through Step 17 in  
“Chapter 6 — Installing the Option 11C Mini” on page 91.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Page 210 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
Start-up procedures  
Procedure 27  
Start-up procedure for a new system installation, using the MSC card  
1
2
Test the power outlet. Make sure that the correct voltage of power is  
present before you plug the power cord into the outlet. The source  
must match the label on the back of the chassis.  
Connect the power cord from the power connector on the back of the  
chassis to an AC power source. See Figure 63. Secure the power  
cable with a cable tie.  
Figure 63  
Power connector on the back of the chassis  
Power cord  
Cable tie  
3
4
Turn the power switch to “ON”.  
Observe the TTY or terminal screen. The TTY must be connected to  
TTY port 0.  
5
When you have completed the software installation (see “Installing  
software in a new system” on page 215), observe the screen again.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 211 of 332  
6
Perform an EDD using Overlay 43.  
After the system is loaded, a menu-driven program called the  
“Software Installation Program” is automatically called up.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Procedure 28  
Start-up procedure for a previously installed system  
1
Test the power outlet. Make sure that the correct voltage of power is  
present before you plug the power cord into the outlet. The source  
must match the label on the back of the chassis.  
2
Connect the power cord from the power connector on the back of the  
chassis to an AC power source. See Figure 63. Secure the power  
cable with a cable tie.  
3
4
Turn the power switch to “ON”.  
Observe the TTY or terminal screen.  
Messages appear on the TTY or the terminal screen. When the  
message “INIXXX” appears, the system is in operation.  
5
6
If required, set the system time and date using Overlay 2.  
Perform an EDD using Overlay 43.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Software Installation Program  
The Software Installation Program provides a menu-driven method of  
selecting from the different options of installing, modifying, or upgrading the  
following:  
software  
customer data  
feature set  
Incremental Software Management (ISM) parameters  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 212 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
The flash ROM stores information about the selections. The information is a  
list of instructions that the program follows when it runs.  
Starting the program  
The Software Installation Program must run from TTY 0 (port 0 on card 0).  
The following are the two methods of starting the Software Installation  
Program:  
Issue the “upgrade” command in Overlay 143.  
Press the <Control> I keys while the terminal screen displays the  
installation prompt during SYSLOAD.  
Note: When you turn on a new system before you have installed the  
software, the Software Installation Program is called up automatically.  
Function selection  
The Software Installation Program is menu-driven. The main menu provides  
the core functionality of the program. The Software Installation Program  
includes the following key functions:  
installs software in a new system  
upgrades and modifies software in an existing system  
uses utilities to work with archived databases, review data, back up data,  
undo an installation in progress, and clear unwanted data.  
After you have made all installation or upgrade selections, you must enter  
valid keycodes. The system validates the keycode. If you enter an invalid  
keycode, the installation function does not continue.  
Note: If you enter a keycode that is not valid, the software and databases  
on the present system are not affected.  
When the keycode validation passes, the software is installed on the system.  
The Software Installation Program has the following additional options:  
Clear Upgrade Information: If the installation terminates after you  
have entered the keycodes, but before the installation is complete, you  
can abort the installation with the “Clear Upgrade Information” option.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 213 of 332  
Confirm Upgrade Information: This option allows you to review the  
selected installation options. You can use the “Confirm Upgrade  
Information” after the system validates the keycodes, but before the  
installation is complete.  
Set system time and date: The system time and date is usually set before  
installation. This makes sure that all flash drive files have the correct  
creation date.  
Keycodes  
A security keycode system protects the installation of software, feature set,  
and ISM parameters. The installation does not continue unless you enter the  
correct keycodes.  
You require keycodes for each new installation, and for existing system  
upgrades. Keycodes are on a Keycode Data Sheet, which is supplied with the  
software and security device. There is a different keycode assigned to each  
site for a particular combination of items, such as software release, feature set,  
and ISM parameters.  
Note: Contact your Nortel Networks representative if the Keycode Data  
Sheet is missing.  
The Software Installation Program validates the keycodes. If the keycodes are  
valid, the installation function continues.  
If the system rejects the keycodes that you enter, the installation function  
stops. Take one of the following actions:  
Check the software and make sure that it is the correct version for this  
site.  
Check the feature set and make sure you entered the correct data.  
Check the keycodes and make sure you entered the correct keycodes.  
Check the ISM parameters and make sure you entered the correct data.  
Abort the installation.  
The system limits the validation of keycodes to three consecutive attempts.  
After the third unsuccessful attempt, the Software Installation Program  
returns to the main menu. Any data entered during this session is lost.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 214 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
Feature set and ISM parameters  
The Software Installation Program allows the selection of a feature set to be  
installed and enabled on the Option 11C Mini system. A feature set, such as  
Enhanced Business or Networking Services, has an associated list of software  
packages and ISM parameters. The Software Delivery Card can include  
several preconfigured feature sets.  
The Software Installation Program also allows the addition of individual  
packages from the feature set and the changing of ISM system parameters.  
Additions and changes are keycode controlled; therefore, the packages and  
ISM parameters must match those corresponding to the site’s keycodes.  
Note: The Software Installation Program does not check the  
prerequisites and interactions of added packages.  
Security Device  
A Security Device comes with each new Option 11C Mini system. Attach this  
device to the component side of the NTDK97 MSC card at the time of initial  
installation. The Security Device remains there for the life of the system.  
AUX ID  
Enter the AUX ID using the Software Installation Program. For new Option  
11C Mini sites, the AUX ID is the system security ID. When assigned, the  
AUX ID remains for the life of the system.  
Customer database  
The Software Installation Program allows the installation of a customer  
database from one of the following sources:  
Preconfigured database  
The Software Delivery card can include several preconfigured databases and  
their associated feature sets. In addition, a minimal database is provided  
which contains basic system configuration information with no customer  
data.  
Archived database  
The Software Installation Program allows the archiving of various databases  
which can be used later at Option 11C Mini sites. It allows multiple databases  
to be configured off-site and then installed ready-to-use at customer sites.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 215 of 332  
Note: Off-site programming of databases is subject to all security  
keycode restrictions. The off-site system must either use the Security  
Device that will be installed in the Option 11C Mini at the customer site,  
or must have its own keycodes for the feature set used.  
Remote restored database  
A database can be restored remotely using the Overlay 143 CCBR remote  
restore command.  
Backed up Database  
be installed. It is provided to recover a customer database if the customer  
database on the primary flash drive becomes corrupted.  
Installing software in a new system  
Before beginning the software installation process, complete Step 1 through  
Step 20 in “Summary of installation procedures” on page 92. You must  
install the security device on the MSC card, and you must have the Keycode  
Data Sheet available.  
Note: In the menus and screens, there are references to Option 11 and  
Option 11E. These references do not apply to the Option 11C Mini.  
Summary of steps  
The following list summarizes the Software Installation steps:  
Setting the system time and date  
Selecting the New System Installation menu  
Selecting Feature Set and packages  
Selecting a database  
Selecting Incremental Software Management (ISM)  
parameters  
Validating keycodes  
Loading the software  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 216 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
Procedure 29  
Installing software  
1
Make sure the MSC card is in CPU slot (slot 0) of the Main  
Chassis.  
For first-time installations, software is installed from the MSC card.  
Software is loaded on the MSC card before it is sent to the customer  
site.  
2
Observe the terminal screen.  
One of two messages appear, and the software installation continues  
accordingly. If the message is:  
INSERT SOFTWARE DELIVERY CARD  
Go to Step 3.  
OR if the following is displayed:  
SOFTWARE INSTALLATION PROGRAM  
go to Step 4 on page 217.  
3
Skip this step unless you are using the Software Delivery (PCMCIA) to  
install the software.  
If you have not already done so, install the Software Delivery card  
in Slot A in the socket in the faceplate of the MSC card.  
Note: You do not have to turn off the system power before you install  
the Software Delivery card in Slot A.  
See Figure 64.  
Insert the card in slot A in the PCMCIA socket located in the faceplate  
of the NTDK97 MSC card. Carefully press on the Software Delivery  
card until it is firmly seated. See Figure 64.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 217 of 332  
Figure 64  
PCMCIA card slot location  
Software Delivery  
card  
in Slot A  
4
Observe the terminal screen.  
If the screen displays the following:  
Current system time and date: 00:00:00 -- 00/00/00  
go to Step 5 on page 218.  
OR if the screen displays the following:  
Software Installation Main Menu  
go to Step 6 on page 218.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 218 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
5
Set the system Time and Date.  
Note: The Time and Date prompt appears when the Install Setup  
Program detects a system Year Date that is not in the range of  
1995-2095. The responses shown below are examples of how to enter  
the system Time and Date:  
Enter new time (hh/mm/ss)  
08:00:00 <cr>  
Enter new date (yy/mm/dd)  
95/05/01 <cr>  
08:00:00 -- 95/05/01 is the new system time and date  
y <cr>  
6
Select item 1 from the Main Menu if you are installing the software from  
the MSC card. Although the MSC card does not have a software  
daughterboard, item 1 is the correct selection.  
If you are installing from a Software Delivery card, select item 4.  
Software Installation Main Menu  
1. New System Installation - From Software Daughterboard  
2. System Upgrade  
3. Utilities  
4. New System Installation - From Software Delivery Card  
[q]uit, [h]elp or [?], <cr> - redisplay  
Enter selection  
1 <cr>  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 219 of 332  
7
Select the Feature Set to be enabled.  
Note: The Feature Set selected must match the one provided with  
keycodes. The Feature Set names shown below are examples only.  
Select Feature Set You Wish to Enable:  
1. General Services (NTSKxxxx)  
2. Enhanced Services (NTSKxxxx)  
3. Call Center Services (NTSKxxxx)  
4. Enhanced Call Center Services (NTSKxxxx)  
[q]uit, [p]revious, [m]ain menu, [h]elp or [?], <cr> redisplay  
(example only:)  
Enter Selection: 2 <cr> (Enhanced Services)  
Indicate if you want to add packages.  
Feature Set Selection: Enhanced Services  
Do you wish to add packages?  
8
Select no, yes, or abort:  
n <cr> (no)  
y <cr> (yes)  
a <cr> (abort)  
Note: Abort returns you to the main menu.  
If the response was NO go to Step 11 on page 220.  
If the response was YES go to Step 9.  
9
Select the Feature packages that you want to add.  
Summary of Packages selected is:  
0-2 4-5 7-14 16-25 28-29 32-64 67 70-77 79-83 86-93 95 98-104 107-111  
113-116 118-120 122-125 127-129 131-133 135 137-141 167  
Enter packages (s) to be added, blank line to end:  
215-235 <cr>  
Note: A Carriage Return, <CR>, ends selection entry or if no  
packages are to be added.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 220 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
10  
Confirm Feature Set and packages.  
Your Feature Set Selection is “Enhanced Services”:  
Additional Packages selected: 215-235  
Summary of Packages selected is:  
0-2 4-5 7-14 16-25 28-29 32-64 67 70-77 79-83 86-93 95 100-104 107-111  
113-116 118-120 122-125 127-129 131-133 135 137-141 167  
...  
...  
200-208 215-235  
Is this selection correct?  
n <cr> (no)  
y <cr> (yes)  
If the response was NO go to Step 7 on page 219.  
If the response was YES go to Step 11 on page 220.  
Select a Database.  
11  
If you are installing from a Software Delivery (PCMCIA) card go to  
Step 12 on page 221.  
IF you are installing from an MSC card, continue here:  
Select database to Install:  
1. Pre-Configured database - Enhanced Services  
2. Basic Configuration  
3. CCBR Restore File  
4. Option 11/11E Software Cartridge  
[q]uit, [p]revious, [m]ain menu, [h]elp or [?], <cr> redisplay  
Enter Selection: 1 or 2 <cr>  
Note: Use Options 3 and 4 when upgrading an Option 11/11E to an  
Option 11C. There is no supported upgrade path from Option 11/11E  
to Option 11C Mini. Therefore, do not use these options for the Option  
11C Mini.  
If you selected 1 or 2, go to Step 14 on page 222.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 221 of 332  
12  
Select a Database using the PCMCIA card.  
If you are installing from the MSC card, go to Step 11 on page 220.  
If you are installing from a Software Delivery (PCMCIA) card continue  
here:  
Select database to Install:  
1. Pre-Configured database - Enhanced Services  
2. Basic Configuration  
3. Archived Database  
[q]uit, [p]revious, [m]ain menu, [h]elp or [?], <cr> redisplay  
Enter Selection: 3 <cr>  
If you selected 3 ‘Archived Database’, go to Step 13. If you selected 1  
or 2, go to Step 14 on page 222.  
13  
Select an Archived Database.  
The terminal screen displays the available archived databases. The  
following are examples only.  
Archived Database available:  
1. Company ABC  
2. XYZ.Offices  
3. Green.Packaging  
[q]uit, [m]ain menu, [p]revious menu, <cr> - redisplay  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 222 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
14  
Review ISM parameters.  
Note: On a new installation, the ISM parameters displayed on the  
terminal screen are the default settings related to the Feature Set  
selection. You can accept these settings without changes or change  
the settings to meet the requirements of the new system.  
Current ISM Parameters:  
TNS (1000) (maximum number of terminal numbers)  
ACDN (0300) (maximum number of ACD DNs)  
AST (0100) (maximum number of associate Sets)  
LTID (0100) (maximum number of Logical Terminal IDs)  
RAN_CON (0012) (default RAN connection)  
RAN_RTE (9999) (default RAN routes)  
MUS_CON (0100) (default MUS connection)  
BRAND (0) (brandline)  
ACD AGENTS (1000) (maximum number of ACD agents)  
ANALOGUE TELEPHONES (0100) (maximum number of analogue sets)  
BRI DSL (0100) (maximum number of Digital Subscriber Loops)  
DIGITAL TELEPHONES (0100) (maximum number Digital sets)  
WIRELESS TELEPHONES ( 0) (maximum number Wireless sets)  
TMDI D-CHANNELS (  
0) (maximum number of channels)  
MOPT (0000) (Meridian Mail option)  
Note: The above underscores represent a space.  
Do you wish to change ISM parameters?  
n <cr>  
y <cr>  
a <cr>  
(no change)  
(change)  
(abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was YES go to Step 15 on page 223.  
If the response was NO go to Step 17 on page 225.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 223 of 332  
15  
Select ISM parameters.  
Enter new ISM parameters, <cr> to leave as is:  
TNS (1000)  
ACDN (0300)  
AST (0100)  
LTID (0100)  
RAN_CON (0012)  
RAN_RTE (9999)  
MUS_CON (0100)  
BRAND (0)  
ACD AGENTS (1000)  
ANALOGUE TELEPHONES (0100)  
BRI DSL (0100)  
DIGITAL TELEPHONES (0100)  
WIRELESS TELEPHONES ( 0)  
TMDI D-CHANNELS (  
MOPT (0000)  
0)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 224 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
16  
Confirm ISM parameters.  
New ISM parameters are:  
TNS (1000)  
ACDN (0300)  
AST (0100)  
LTID (0100)  
RAN_CON (0012)  
RAN_RTE (9999)  
MUS_CON (0100)  
BRAND (0)  
ACD AGENTS (1000)  
ANALOGUE TELEPHONES (0100)  
BRI DSL (0100)  
DIGITAL TELEPHONES (0100)  
WIRELESS TELEPHONES ( 0)  
TMDI D-CHANNELS (  
MOPT (0000)  
Is this correct?  
n <cr> (no)  
0)  
y <cr> (yes)  
a <cr> (abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was NO go to Step 14 on page 222.  
If the response was YES go to Step 17 on page 225.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 225 of 332  
17  
Define the AUX ID.  
Note: The default AUX ID is the system ID provided with the Option  
11C Mini.  
Security ID: 20000326  
Current AUX ID: 20000326  
Do you wish to change the AUX ID?  
y <cr> (yes)  
n <cr> (no)  
a <cr> (abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was NO go to Step 19 on page 226.  
If the response was YES go to Step 18 on page 225.  
Enter the AUX ID.  
18  
Enter the AUX ID, as printed on the Keycode Data Sheet. Enter a <cr> to  
maintain.  
<cr> to maintain  
12121212 <cr>  
New AUX ID: 12121212  
Is this correct?  
y <cr> (yes)  
n <cr> (no)  
a <cr> (abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was NO go to Step 17 on page 225.  
If the response was YES go to Step 19 on page 226.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 226 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
19  
Review and confirm information entered.  
New Installation Information Summary:  
Security ID: 20000326  
Aux ID: 20000326  
Added Pkgs: 215-235  
Feature Set: Enhanced Business  
Database: Company.ABC  
S/W Release: 2304C  
ISM Parameters  
TSN: 1000 1000  
AGNT: 1000 1000  
ACDN: 0100 0100  
AST: 0000 0150  
DSL: 0000 0100  
LTID: 0000 0000  
RAN_CON (0010)  
RAN_RTE (9999)  
MUS_CON (0100)  
BRAND (0)  
MOPT: 0000 0000  
Note: The terminal screen displays both the old and the new  
parameter values.  
Is this correct?  
y <cr> (yes)  
n <cr> (no)  
a <cr> (abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was NO go to Step 7 on page 219.  
If the response was YES go to Step 20 on page 227.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software Page 227 of 332  
20  
Enter the keycodes from the Keycode Data Sheet.  
Enter new Keycodes:  
Key 1:  
Key 2:  
Key 3:  
xxxxxxxx <cr>  
yyyyyyyy <cr>  
zzzzzzzz <cr>  
After you enter the last keycode, the system displays a successful or  
unsuccessful message. Follow the instructions given below.  
‘Keycode validation successful’  
***WARNING*** A system restart will occur as part of the software  
installation process”  
If the successful message appears go to Step 21 on page 227.  
‘Keycode validation unsuccessful’  
If the unsuccessful message appears, repeat this step (Step 20).  
After three unsuccessful keycode validation attempts, the following  
message appears:  
Keycode validation unsuccessful.  
Installation aborted...returning to main menu.  
Complete the software installation.  
Are you sure you wish to perform the installation?  
21  
n <cr> (no)  
a <cr> (abort, return to main menu)  
If the response was YES, this is the end of the Software Installation  
program. The system will now start to sysload. See Procedure 27  
Step 5 on page 210.  
If the response was NO, go to Step 6 on page 218.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 228 of 332  
Chapter 16 — Starting the Option 11C Mini and installing software  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
252  
Page 229 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
page 36 for a list of telephones and Attendant Consoles supported by the  
Option 11C Mini.  
This chapter contains the following procedures:  
Procedure 30: “Cross connecting telephones” on page 230  
Procedure 31: “Connecting telephones without a PFTU” on page 234  
Procedure 32: “Connecting 500/2500-type telephones with a PFTU” on  
page 234  
Procedure 33: “Connecting an off-premise telephone” on page 236  
display” on page 246  
Procedure 36: “Activating a default model telephone without a character  
display” on page 248  
Procedure 37: “Activating a customized telephone” on page 249  
Procedure 38: “Activating a customized telephone” on page 250  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 230 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Refer to the instructions provided with the telephone or Attendant Console  
and to the following documents for detailed information about installing  
telephones and Attendant Consoles:  
(553-3001-215)  
Meridian 1 European Digital Telephones (553-3001-114)  
M3900 Series Meridian Digital Telephone Description, Installation, and  
Refer to “Appendix A – Preprogrammed data” on page 285 for information  
about preprogrammed data.  
Before you continue, install the cable from the slot that contains the line card  
associated with the telephone being connected. Refer to “Chapter 13 —  
Installing and connecting the cross-connect terminal” on page 169, if you  
require additional cable installation.  
WARNING  
Always use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines. Do  
not install telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Do not install  
telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is designed for wet  
locations. Never touch uninsulated telephone wiring unless the line is  
disconnected at the network interface.  
Cross connecting telephones  
Connect the telephones according to Figures 65 and 66. Figure 67 on page  
233 shows the cross-connect information for the 48-port Digital Line Card.  
Procedure 30  
Cross connecting telephones  
1
2
Locate the telephone terminations at the cross-connect terminal.  
Connect the Z-type cross-connect wire to the leads of the  
telephone.  
3
Locate line circuit card (TN) terminations at the cross-connect  
terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 231 of 332  
4
Connect the other end of the cross-connect wire to the assigned  
TN terminal block.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Figure 65  
NE-500/2500-type telephone cross connections  
Lead  
Cable pairs  
designation  
Line  
Pack  
Cross connect  
terminal  
Unit  
0
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
O-W  
T
R
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Unit  
1
Unit  
2
W-G  
G-W  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
T
R
T
R
Unit  
3
W-BR  
BR-W  
Unit  
4
W-S  
S-W  
T
R
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Unit  
5
R-BL  
BL-R  
Unit  
6
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
R-O  
O-R  
T
R
T
R
Unit  
7
Unit  
8
R-G  
G-R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
T
R
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Unit  
9
R-S  
S-R  
Unit  
10  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
T
R
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Unit  
11  
BK-O  
O-BK  
Unit  
12  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
T
R
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Unit  
13  
Unit  
14  
BK-S  
S-BK  
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Unit  
15  
T
R
To 500/2500-type  
telephone  
553-8349.EPS  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 232 of 332  
Figure 66  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Meridian Digital Telephone cross connections  
Pack  
connector  
Telephone connecting  
block, or connector  
PE shelf  
Line  
pack  
Cross connect  
block  
G
R
T0  
R0  
Line cord  
to telephone  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
T0  
R0  
Unit 0  
Unit 1  
W
B
For Power  
Supply leads  
T1  
R1  
27  
2
T1  
R1  
W-O  
O-W  
to telephone  
T14  
R14  
Unit 14  
Unit 15  
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
T14  
R14  
to telephone  
to telephone  
T15  
R15  
40  
16  
T15  
R15  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Part of  
25 pair cable  
Shelf  
connector  
Part of 25  
pair cable  
553-8350.EPS  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 233 of 332  
Figure 67  
48-port Digital Line Card cross connections  
Lead  
Cable pairs  
designation  
Line  
Card  
Cross connect  
terminal  
Unit  
0
Line cord  
G
R
W-BL  
BL-W  
W-O  
T0  
R0  
T1  
R1  
to telephone  
W
B
For Power  
Supply loads  
Unit  
1
To telephone  
O-W  
Unit  
2
W-G  
G-W  
T2  
R2  
T3  
R3  
To telephone  
To telephone  
Unit  
3
W-BR  
BR-W  
C
a
r
d
Unit  
12  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
T0  
R0  
T1  
R1  
To telephone  
To telephone  
4
Unit  
13  
Unit  
14  
BK-S  
S-BK  
T2  
R2  
T3  
R3  
To telephone  
To telephone  
Unit  
15  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Unit  
0
Y-O  
O-Y  
T16  
R16  
T17  
R17  
To telephone  
To telephone  
Unit  
1
Y-G  
G-Y  
Unit  
2
Y-BY  
BY-Y  
T18  
R18  
T19  
R19  
To telephone  
To telephone  
C
a
r
Unit  
3
Y-S  
S-Y  
d
Unit  
4
T20  
R20  
T21  
R21  
V-BL  
BL-V  
V-O  
6
To telephone  
To telephone  
Unit  
5
O-V  
Unit  
6
T22  
R22  
V-G  
G-V  
To telephone  
To telephone  
T23  
R23  
V-BV  
BV-V  
Unit  
7
553-9489  
Note: Figure 67 is an example which shows the cross connections for  
the Card 4/Card 6 connector. The Card 5/Card 6 connector provides  
cable pairs for Card 5 units 0-15 and Card 6 units 8-15.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 234 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Connecting telephones without a PFTU  
Procedure 31  
Connecting telephones without a PFTU  
1
2
Locate the telephone terminations on the cross-connect terminal.  
Connect one end of the cross-connect wire to the leads of the  
telephone.  
3
4
Locate the line card terminations on the cross-connect terminal.  
Refer to Table 49 on page 239.  
Connect the other end of the cross-connect wire to the assigned  
TN terminal block.  
Table 52 on page 242 provides default DN assignments.  
Now, you can activate the telephone, as described on page 244.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Connecting analog (500/2500-type) telephones with a PFTU  
Procedure 32  
Connecting 500/2500-type telephones with a PFTU  
1
2
Locate the telephone terminations on the cross-connect terminal.  
Connect one end of the cross-connect wire to the leads of the  
telephone.  
3
Locate the PFTU connections (unit PFT 1 through PFT 5)  
assigned to this telephone at the cross-connect terminal.  
Refer to Table 50 on page 239.  
4
5
6
Connect the other end of the cross-connect wire to the pair  
assigned to the telephone on the PFTU.  
Connect a second cross-connect wire to the pair assigned to the  
line card on the PFTU.  
Locate the line card terminations on the cross-connect terminal.  
Refer to Table 49 on page 239.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 235 of 332  
7
Connect the other end of the cross-connect wire to the assigned  
TN terminal block.  
Table 52 on page 242 provides the default DN assignments.  
Now, you can activate the telephone, as described on page 244.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Connecting off-premise telephones  
Connect off-premise analog (500/2500-type) telephones through an  
NTAK92AA Off-Premise Protection Module. Each module can connect up  
to four analog (500/2500-type) telephones and can interface with one of the  
following:  
NT1R20 Off-Premise Station Analog Line Card  
NT8D03 Analog Line Card  
NT8D09 Message Waiting Line Card  
WARNING  
The message waiting line card produces -150 volts which is considered  
hazardous on off-premise telephones. Make sure that the -150 V is  
disabled on off-premise telephones.  
The voltage is disabled when the telephone’s Class of Service (CLS) is  
Message Waiting Lamp Denied (LPD) and Message Waiting Denied  
(MWD) in Overlay 10.  
Refer to the X11 Software guides for information about Overlay 10.  
Do not assign a Class of Service of LPA or MWA to an off-premise  
telephone.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 236 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Procedure 33  
Connecting an off-premise telephone  
1
Install the NTAK92AA Off-Premise Protection Module on the wall  
using four #10 1/2 in (minimum) screws.  
2
Connect a #6 AWG (#40 Metric Wire Gauge) from the grounding  
lug at the bottom of the NTAK92AA Off-Premise Protection  
Module to an earth ground. Refer to Figure 68 on page 237.  
2
Note: In the UK, use a 2 mm (#6 AWG) ground lug. In Europe, use a  
2
#6 AWG (16 mm ) ground lug.  
WARNING  
If connecting to a message waiting line card, unseat the card from its  
assigned slot before continuing with the next step.  
3
4
Connect two NTAK9204 cables (one from connector J1 and one  
from connector J2) from the protection module to the  
cross-connect terminal.  
Terminate the cables as shown in Figure 65 on page 231.  
Cross-connect the J1 cable to the Tip and Ring connections  
coming from the line card.  
Table 52 on page 242 provides the default DN assignments.  
5
6
Cross-connect the J2 cable to the off-premise telephone.  
Install the regulatory label provided with the Off-Premise  
Protection Module on the inside right-hand wall of the chassis.  
7
Install the line card in its assigned position.  
Now, you can activate the telephone, as described on page 244.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Connecting an Attendant Console  
Procedure 34  
Connecting Attendant Console  
1
Locate the Attendant Console terminations at the cross-connect  
terminal.  
2
Locate the line card terminations at the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 237 of 332  
3
With cross-connect wire, connect the line card and other  
connections to the console as shown in Figure 69 on page 238.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Figure 68  
NTAK92AA Off-Premise Protection Module connections  
Cross-connect  
terminal block  
T1  
R1  
T2  
R2  
T3  
R3  
T4  
R4  
BL - 1W  
BL - 2W  
O - 1W  
O - 2W  
G - 1W  
G - 2W  
BR - 1W  
BR - 2W  
J2  
To off-premise  
telephones  
NTAK92AA  
Off-Premise  
Protection  
Module  
T1  
R1  
T2  
R2  
T3  
R3  
T4  
R4  
BL - 1W  
BL - 2W  
O - 1W  
O - 2W  
G - 1W  
G - 2W  
BR - 1W  
BR - 2W  
To analogue  
line card in  
Option 11  
cabinet  
J1  
Ground lug  
Connector J2  
Connector J1  
NTAK9204  
Cable  
NTAK9204  
Cable  
553-8351.EPS  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 238 of 332  
Figure 69  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Attendant Console connections  
Console  
connector  
Cross-connect  
block  
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
27  
2
To 1st TN  
To 2nd TN  
W-O  
O-W  
ASM/  
ADN  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
To 3rd TN  
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
33  
8
Cable to  
M2250  
Console  
R-G  
G-R  
Console power can be  
obtained from the  
4th and 5th  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
GND  
TC  
TNs on the circuit card.  
To 4th TN Tip  
To 4th TN Ring  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
+VPS  
41  
16  
42  
17  
(Note 2)  
+VPS RTN  
Y-O  
O-Y  
To 5th TN Tip  
To 5th TN Ring  
(Note 1)  
Cable from  
console to  
cross-connect  
terminal  
Relay 2  
Relay 1  
V-S  
S-V  
50  
25  
Note 1: The M2250 is powered through the line circuits.  
In addition to the primary TN, secondary TN and ASMTN, two TNs are cabled to  
the M2250. Maximum loop length is 3000 ft (915 m) of 24 AWG (5.0 Metric Wire Gauge).  
Note 2: When additional options are used (BLF) an additional 16V dc power supply is  
required. The 16V dc source is cabled through +VPS and +VPS RTN leads. The maximum  
distance from the console to the power source is 120 ft (36 m) of 24 AWG (5.0 Metric Wire Gauge) wire.  
553-8352.EPS  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 239 of 332  
Table 49  
Terminal Number assignments — Main Chassis and Chassis Expander  
Physical slot  
Logical slot  
First TN...Last TN Cable  
Chassis  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
01 00...01 15  
02 00...02 15  
03 00...03 15  
Card 1  
Card 2  
Card 3  
Main  
Main  
Main  
Card 4/Card 6  
(see note)  
4
5
6
04 00...04 15  
05 00...05 15  
06 00...06 07  
06 08...06 15  
Main  
Main  
Main  
Main  
Card 5/Card 6  
(see note)  
Card 4/Card 6  
(see note)  
Card 5/Card 6  
(see note)  
7
7
07 00...07 15  
08 00...08 15  
09 00...09 15  
10 00...10 15  
Card 7  
Card 8  
Card 9  
Card 10  
Expander  
Expander  
Expander  
8
8
9
9
10  
10  
Refer to the labels on the back of the Main Chassis. See Figure 52 on page 179.  
Note:  
Table 50  
Power Failure Transfer Unit connections  
QUA6 J1 Cable  
Function  
Pair  
Color  
Connects to  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
Connect to the telephone  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
Connect to the telephone  
line card  
PFT 1  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
Connect to the trunk line  
card  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 240 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Table 50  
Power Failure Transfer Unit connections (Continued)  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
Connect to the telephone  
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
Connect to the telephone  
line card  
PFT 2  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
Connect to the trunk line  
card  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
Connect to the telephone  
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
Connect to the telephone  
line card  
PFT 3  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Connect to the trunk line  
card  
17T  
17R  
Y-O  
O-Y  
Connect to the telephone  
PFT 4  
18T  
18R  
Y-G  
G-Y  
Connect to the telephone  
line card  
19T  
19R  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
20T  
20R  
Y-S  
S-Y  
Connect to the trunk line  
card  
21T  
21R  
V-BL  
BL-V  
Connect to the telephone  
22T  
22R  
V-O  
O-V  
Connect to the telephone  
line card  
PFT 5  
23T  
23R  
V-G  
G-V  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
24T  
24R  
V-BR  
BR-V  
Connect to the trunk line  
card  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 241 of 332  
Table 51  
Color combinations of cable pairs  
W-Bl  
Bl-W  
W-O  
O-W  
W-G  
G-W  
W-BR  
BR-W  
W-S  
S-W  
R-BL  
BL-R  
R-O  
O-R  
R-G  
G-R  
Color  
Unit  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
R-BR  
BR-R  
R-S  
S-R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
BK-O  
O-BK  
BK-G  
G-BK  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Y-B  
B-Y  
Color  
Unit  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
12  
14  
15  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 242 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Table 52 lists the default DN assignments for the Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander.  
Table 52  
Default DN assignments for the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander  
Cable  
Unit  
0 - 7  
Default Directory Number (DN)  
2200  
2208  
2216  
2224  
2232  
2240  
2248  
2256  
2264  
2272  
2280  
2288  
2296  
2304  
2312  
2320  
2328  
2336  
2344  
2352  
2201  
2209  
2217  
2225  
2233  
2241  
2249  
2257  
2265  
2273  
2281  
2289  
2297  
2305  
2313  
2321  
2329  
2337  
2345  
2353  
2202  
2210  
2218  
2226  
2234  
2242  
2250  
2258  
2266  
2274  
2282  
2290  
2298  
2306  
2314  
2322  
2330  
2338  
2346  
2354  
2203  
2211  
2219  
2227  
2235  
2243  
2251  
2259  
2267  
2275  
2283  
2291  
2299  
2307  
2315  
2323  
2331  
2339  
2347  
2355  
2204  
2212  
2220  
2228  
2236  
2244  
2252  
2260  
2268  
2276  
2284  
2292  
2300  
2308  
2316  
2324  
2332  
2340  
2348  
2356  
2205  
2213  
2221  
2229  
2237  
2245  
2253  
2261  
2269  
2277  
2285  
2293  
2301  
2309  
2317  
2325  
2333  
2341  
2349  
2357  
2206  
2214  
2222  
2230  
2238  
2246  
2254  
2262  
2270  
2278  
2286  
2294  
2302  
2310  
2318  
2326  
2334  
2342  
2350  
2358  
2207  
2215  
2223  
2231  
2239  
2247  
2255  
2263  
2271  
2279  
2287  
2295  
2303  
2311  
2319  
2327  
2335  
2343  
2351  
2359  
Card 1  
Card 1 8 - 15  
Card 2 0 - 7  
Card 2 8 - 15  
Card 3 0 - 7  
Card 3 8 - 15  
Card 4 0 - 7  
Card 4 8 - 15  
Card 5 0 - 7  
Card 5 8 - 15  
Card 6 0 - 7  
Card 6 8 - 15  
Card 7 0 - 7  
Card 7 8 - 15  
Card 8 0 - 7  
Card 8 8 - 15  
Card 9 0 - 7  
Card 9 8 - 15  
Card 10 0 - 7  
Card 10 8 - 15  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 243 of 332  
Table 53 lists the default DN assignments for the Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander for Germany.  
Table 53  
Default DN assignments for the Main Chassis and Chassis Expander (Germany)  
Cable  
Unit  
Default Directory Number (DN)  
Card 1 0 - 7  
Card 1 8 - 15  
Card 2 0 - 7  
Card 2 8 - 15  
Card 3 0 - 7  
Card 3 8 - 15  
Card 4 0 - 7  
Card 4 8 - 15  
Card 5 0 - 7  
Card 5 8 - 15  
Card 6 0 - 7  
Card 6 8 - 15  
Card 7 0 - 7  
Card 7 8 - 15  
Card 8 0 - 7  
Card 8 8 - 15  
Card 9 0 - 7  
Card 9 8 - 15  
Card 10 0 - 7  
Card 10 8 - 15  
100  
108  
116  
124  
132  
140  
148  
156  
164  
172  
180  
188  
196  
204  
212  
220  
228  
236  
244  
252  
101  
109  
117  
125  
133  
141  
149  
157  
165  
173  
181  
189  
197  
205  
213  
221  
229  
237  
245  
253  
102  
110  
118  
126  
134  
142  
150  
158  
166  
174  
182  
190  
198  
206  
214  
222  
230  
238  
246  
254  
103  
111  
119  
127  
135  
143  
151  
159  
167  
175  
183  
191  
199  
207  
215  
223  
231  
239  
247  
255  
104  
112  
120  
128  
136  
144  
152  
160  
168  
176  
184  
192  
200  
208  
216  
224  
232  
240  
248  
256  
105  
113  
121  
129  
137  
145  
153  
161  
169  
177  
185  
193  
201  
209  
217  
225  
233  
241  
249  
257  
106  
114  
122  
130  
138  
146  
154  
162  
170  
178  
186  
194  
202  
210  
218  
226  
234  
242  
250  
258  
107  
115  
123  
131  
139  
147  
155  
163  
171  
179  
187  
195  
203  
211  
219  
227  
235  
243  
251  
259  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 244 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Cross-connecting terminal Digital Subscriber Loops  
Refer to ISDN BRI Administration and Maintenance Guide (553-3011-311)  
for a complete description of terminal Digital Subscriber Loops (DSL) cross-  
connecting and installation.  
Activating telephones  
Activating telephones is not difficult. Activate each telephone by performing  
a procedure on the telephone. Automatic Set Configuration is the software  
feature used to activate telephone sets.  
Note: You cannot activate the data feature using the procedures in this  
chapter. To program a telephone with the data feature, configure it in  
LD 11 with Data Class of Service. See the X11 Software Administration  
Guide.  
This chapter contains procedures for activating the following models of  
telephones:  
a default model with a default extension number  
a customized model with a customized extension number  
This chapter provides these procedures for telephones with and without  
character displays.  
Telephone tones  
There are a number of different telephone tones. Table 54 includes tones that  
you hear during telephone activation. Table 55 includes tones that you hear  
during telephone activation in Germany.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 245 of 332  
Table 54  
Telephone tones  
Tone  
Description  
Dial tone  
A continuous tone.  
Special dial tone  
Overflow tone  
Relocation tone  
Three beeps followed by continuous dial tone.  
Like a busy tone, except faster and higher.  
A short high-pitched beep that continues for 4  
seconds, followed by silence.  
Table 55  
Telephone tones for Germany  
Tone  
Description  
Specification  
Dial tone  
Sequences of three short  
beeps with a pause  
between cycles  
Beep: 420 Hz tone for 200 ms  
Pause between beeps: 275 ms  
Pause between cycles: 875 ms  
Special dial  
tone  
Six short beeps followed  
by continuous tone  
Beep: 420 Hz tone for 125 ms  
Pause between beeps: 125 ms  
Overflow tone Continuous beeping, like  
a busy tone  
Beep: 420 Hz tone for 200 ms  
Pause: 600 ms  
Relocation  
tone  
Short, high pitched beep  
followed by silence  
Beep: 1400 Hz tone for 1.4  
seconds  
Note 1: Before you activate a telephone, make sure that you have  
decided on its final location. Also, know the model number assigned to  
the telephone and if it is to be customized.  
Note 2: When you are activating Meridian Digital telephones,  
remember that they are different from the older Meridian Modular  
telephones. Meridian Modular telephones can have a combined total of  
128 model telephones. Meridian Digital telephones can have 128 models  
for each type of telephone. When you activate a Meridian Digital  
telephone, select the model associated with that telephone type, or the  
telephone will not work.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 246 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Activating a default model with a character display  
Procedure 35  
Activating a default model telephone with a character display  
1
Plug the telephone set into the jack and wait 20 seconds before  
you lift the handset. If you do not receive a dial tone, replace the  
handset and wait another 10 seconds before lifting the handset  
again. Repeat this procedure until you receive dial tone.  
If successful, the character display shows either “MODEL? X” (if the  
telephone relocation feature is not in use) or “RELOC OR MODEL? X”  
(if the telephone relocation feature is in use). “X” represents the default  
model for the telephone that you are activating.  
Note: If you do not see the prompt “MODEL X” after lifting the  
handset, disconnect the telephone from the wall jack. Wait five  
seconds, and insert the telephone into the jack again. The telephone  
now shows “MODEL X” when you lift the handset.  
Note: The system requires the 20 second time interval to determine if  
the set is new or if it is being relocated using the Modular Telephone  
Relocation feature.  
2
Press the pound key (#) to select the default model.  
The character display shows “OK, EXTENSION? XXXX”. “XXXX”  
represents the default extension number for this telephone type.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 247 of 332  
3
Press the pound key again to select the default extension  
number.  
You hear the relocation tone. The character display shows “OK”.  
OR  
If the extension number is already in use by another telephone, you  
hear the special dial tone. If the telephone has a display it shows  
“MULTI-LINE, EXTENSION?”.  
To accept the default extension number, press the pound key.  
To select a new extension number, manually enter an extension  
number and press the pound key.  
OR  
If the extension number is not available for use, the character display  
shows “ERROR, EXTENSION?“ and you hear overflow tone.  
This situation occurs when you select an extension number manually,  
or when extension numbers are entered for additional keys. A default  
extension number will not be offered if it is not available.  
You must repeat step 3 and manually enter a new extension number.  
Note 1: If other keys require secondary extension numbers, you are  
prompted until you enter all of the required extension numbers for the  
model.  
Note 2: These extension numbers cannot be defaulted. The text display  
that prompts for additional extension numbers is “KEY kk EXT?” where  
“kk” represents the key number requiring the extension number.  
Note 3: Each prompt for another extension number is accompanied by  
special dial tone. When you are programming an extension number, the  
lamp associated with that number on the telephone is lit.  
4
Hang up the telephone receiver.  
After approximately 10 seconds, the telephone is configured.  
Note: If you replace the handset before completing the prompt  
sequence, the installation will automatically fail. This can be useful if  
you make an error and want to restart the procedure.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 248 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Activating a default model without a character display  
Procedure 36  
Activating a default model telephone without a character display  
1
Plug the telephone set into the jack and wait 20 seconds before  
you lift the handset. If you do not receive dial tone, replace the  
handset and wait another 10 seconds before going off-hook  
again. Repeat this procedure until you receive dial tone.  
Note: The system requires the 20 second time interval to determine if  
the set is new or if it is being relocated using the Modular Telephone  
Relocation feature.  
2
3
Press the pound key (#) to select the default model.  
Press the pound key (#) again to select the default extension  
number.  
You hear a short, high-pitched beep which lasts four seconds followed  
by silence (relocation tone).  
Note: If the extension number is already in use by another telephone,  
you hear three beeps followed by continuous dial tone (special dial tone).  
To accept the default extension number press the pound key (#).  
To select a new extension number, manually enter an extension  
number and press the pound key.  
If the extension number is not available for use, you hear a fast,  
high-pitched broken tone (overflow tone). This happens when you  
select an extension number manually or when extension numbers are  
entered for additional keys. A default extension number is not offered  
if it is not available. You must repeat Step 3 on page 248, and you must  
manually enter a new extension number.  
Note: If other keys require secondary extension numbers, you are  
prompted until you enter all of the required extension numbers for the  
model. These extension numbers cannot be defaulted. You are  
prompted for each additional extension number with three beeps  
followed by continuous dial tone (special dial tone). When you are  
programming an extension number, the lamp associated with that  
number on the telephone is lit.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 249 of 332  
Activating a customized model with a character display  
Procedure 37  
Activating a customized telephone  
1
Plug the telephone set into the jack and wait 20 seconds before  
you lift the handset. If you do not receive dial tone, replace the  
handset and wait another 10 seconds before going off-hook  
again. Repeat this procedure until you receive dial tone.  
If successful, the character display shows either “MODEL? X” (if the  
telephone relocation feature is not in use) or “RELOC OR MODEL? X”  
(if the telephone relocation feature is in use). “X” represents the default  
model for the telephone that you are activating.  
Note 1: If you do not see the prompt “MODEL X” after lifting the  
handset, disconnect the telephone from the wall jack. Wait five seconds  
and plug the telephone into the jack again. The telephone now shows  
“MODEL X” when you lift the handset.  
Note 2: The system requires the 20 second time interval to determine if  
the set is new or if it is being relocated using the Modular Telephone  
Relocation feature.  
2
3
Enter the digits associated with the customized model and press  
the pound key (#).  
Dial tone disappears after you press the first digit. You hear special dial  
tone after you press the pound key. If you enter a valid model number,  
the character display reads “OK, EXTENSION?”. If you enter an invalid  
model, the previous prompt is reissued and you hear overflow tone.  
Enter the customized extension number and press the pound  
key.  
You hear relocation tone. The character display shows “OK”.  
OR  
If the extension number is already in use by another telephone, you  
hear special dial tone again. The character display shows  
“MULTI-LINE, EXTENSION?”.  
OR  
If the extension number is not available for use, you hear overflow  
tone. The character display shows “ERROR, EXTENSION?” and you  
must repeat this step.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 250 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
Note: If other keys require secondary extension numbers, you are  
prompted until you enter all of the required extension numbers for the  
model. These extension numbers cannot be defaulted. The text display  
prompting for more extension numbers is “KEY kk EXT?” where “kk”  
represents the key number requiring the extension number. Each prompt  
for another extension number is accompanied by special dial tone. When  
you are programming an extension number, the lamp associated with that  
number on the telephone is lit.  
4
Hang up the telephone handset.  
After approximately 10 seconds, the telephone is configured.  
Note: If you replace the handset before you complete the prompt  
sequence, the installation automatically fails. This can be useful if you  
make an error and want to restart the procedure.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Activating a customized model without a character display  
Procedure 38  
Activating a customized telephone  
1
Plug the telephone set into the jack and wait 20 seconds before  
you lift the handset. If you do not receive dial tone, replace the  
handset and wait another 10 seconds before going off-hook  
again. Repeat this procedure until you receive dial tone.  
Note: The system requires the 20 second time interval to determine if  
the set is new or if it is being relocated using the Modular Telephone  
Relocation feature.  
2
Enter the digits associated with the customized model and press  
the pound key (#).  
Dial tone disappears after you press the first digit. You hear three  
beeps followed by continuous dial tone (special dial tone) after you  
press the pound key.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones Page 251 of 332  
3
Enter the customized extension number and press the pound  
key.  
You hear a short high-pitched beep which lasts four seconds, followed  
by silence (relocation tone).  
If the extension number is already in use by another telephone, you  
hear special dial tone again.  
If the extension number is not available for use, you hear a fast,  
high-pitched broken tone (overflow tone), and you must repeat this  
step.  
4
Hang up the telephone handset.  
After approximately 10 seconds, the telephone is configured.  
Note: If other keys require secondary extension numbers, you are  
prompted until you enter all of the required extension numbers for the  
model. These extension numbers cannot be defaulted. You are  
prompted for each additional extension number with three beeps  
followed by continuous dial tone (special dial tone). When you are  
programming an extension number, the lamp associated with that  
number on the telephone is lit.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Activating terminals on a DSL  
Refer to the ISDN BRI Administration and Maintenance Guide  
(553-3011-311) for information about activating and initializing the terminals  
that can be connected to a terminal DSL.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 252 of 332  
Chapter 17 — Connecting the telephones  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
278  
Page 253 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
or without the use of a Power Failure Transfer Unit (PFTU). This chapter  
contains the following procedures:  
Procedure 39: “Connecting trunks without a PFTU” on page 254  
Procedure 40: “Connecting trunks with a PFTU” on page 254  
Procedure 41: “Activating a default model trunk” on page 275  
Procedure 42: “Activating a selected model trunk” on page 276  
The QUA6 PFTU operates with loop start and ground start CO trunks.  
However, with ground-start trunks the related telephone set must have a  
ground-start button.  
During initial software installation on the Option 11C Mini, you can load a  
default database, containing preprogrammed trunk data, into software. If  
necessary, you can modify the default data at any time to meet the specific  
needs of a customer. For a description of how to modify preprogrammed  
trunking data, refer to “Appendix A – Preprogrammed data” on page 285 in  
this Guide.  
WARNING  
Always use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.  
Avoid installing telephone wiring during a lightning storm. Do not  
install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is designed for  
wet locations. Never touch uninsulated telephone wiring unless the  
line is disconnected at the network interface.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 254 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Connecting trunks without a PFTU  
Procedure 39  
Connecting trunks without a PFTU  
1
2
From the assignment record, determine the location of the trunk  
connection and its associated Terminal Number (TN) at the  
cross-connect terminal.  
With cross-connect wire, connect the trunk to the TN.  
Make sure that the wiring is not reversed and is on the correct  
terminals.  
Tables 57 to 59 list the connections for trunks. For trunk connections  
for Europe, see Tables 60 to 68. For trunk connections for the UK, see  
Tables 69 to 75.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Connecting trunks with a PFTU  
Procedure 40  
Connecting trunks with a PFTU  
1
2
Locate the PFTU terminal blocks at the cross-connect terminal.  
Cross-connect the first pair of the assigned PFT to the telephone.  
See Table 56 on page 255 for PFTU connections.  
3
Cross-connect the second pair of the PFT to the TN assigned to  
the telephone.  
4
5
Cross-connect the third pair of the PFT to the central office trunk.  
Cross-connect the third pair of the PFT to the TN assigned to the  
trunk.  
6
Repeat for each trunk assigned to the PFTU.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 255 of 332  
Table 56  
Power Failure Transfer Unit connections  
QUA6 J1 cable  
Function  
Pair  
Color  
Connects to  
Comments  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
Connect to the  
telephone  
P
F
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
Connect to the  
telephone line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the telephone  
T
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
1
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
Connect to the trunk  
line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the trunk  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
Connect to the  
telephone  
P
F
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
Connect to the  
telephone line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the telephone  
T
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
2
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
Connect to the trunk  
line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the trunk  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
Connect to the  
telephone  
P
F
14T  
14R  
BK-BR Connect to the  
BR-BK telephone line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the telephone  
T
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
3
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Connect to the trunk  
line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the trunk  
17T  
17R  
Y- O  
O-Y  
Connect to the  
telephone  
P
F
18T  
18R  
Y- G  
G-Y  
Connect to the  
telephone line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the telephone  
T
19T  
19R  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
4
20T  
20R  
Y-S  
S-Y  
Connect to the trunk  
line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the trunk  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 256 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
21T  
21R  
V-BL  
BL-V  
Connect to the  
telephone  
P
F
22T  
22R  
V-O  
O-V  
Connect to the  
telephone line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the telephone  
T
23T  
23R  
V-G  
G-V  
Connect to the central  
office trunk  
5
24T  
24R  
V-BR  
BR-V  
Connect to the trunk  
line card  
Connect to TN assigned to  
the trunk  
Trunk connections  
NT8D14 Universal trunk card  
The Universal trunk card provides eight analog trunks that can function in the  
modes shown in Table 57.  
Table 57  
NT8D14 Universal trunk — modes and option settings  
Jumper  
Modes  
Location  
strap  
Central (CO)  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
2- way TIE trunk (loop Dial Repeat)  
2 - way TIE trunk (Outgoing Incoming  
Dial)  
Recorded Announcement (RAN)  
Paging trunk  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
J1, J2  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Japan CO/DID operation  
DID operation  
Loop length>2000 ¾  
DID operation  
J1, J2  
OFF  
Loop length <2000¾  
OFF indicates that no strap is present.  
Note:  
J1 and J2 locations apply to all eight trunks.  
Refer to Table 58 on page 257 for the connections to the NT8D14 Universal  
trunk at the cross-connect terminal.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 257 of 332  
Table 58  
NT8D14 Universal trunk connections  
RAN  
mode  
Paging  
mode  
All other  
modes  
Cable from chassis  
Pair  
Color  
Designations  
1T  
W-BL  
BL-W  
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
Unit  
0
1R  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
Unit  
1
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
Unit  
2
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
Unit  
3
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
T4  
R4  
T4  
R4  
T4  
R4  
Unit  
4
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
T5  
R5  
T5  
R5  
T5  
R5  
Unit  
5
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
T6  
R6  
T6  
R6  
T6  
R6  
Unit  
6
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
T7  
R7  
T7  
R7  
T7  
R7  
Unit  
7
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
CP  
MB  
A
PG  
Remaining pairs are spare  
Note:  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 258 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
NT8D15 E&M Trunk card  
Table 59  
NT8D15 E&M Trunk card  
Cables  
Card 1 through  
Card 10 from  
chassis  
2W  
Paging  
mode  
2W  
Type 1  
mode  
4W  
Type 1  
mode  
4W  
Type 2  
mode  
Pair  
Color  
Designations  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
Unit  
0
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
E
M
E
M
EA  
EB  
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
A
PG  
ESC  
ESCG  
MA  
MB  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
Unit  
1
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
E
M
E
M
EA  
EB  
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
A
PG  
ESC  
ESCG  
MA  
MB  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
Unit  
2
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
E
M
E
M
EA  
EB  
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
A
PG  
ESC  
ESCG  
MA  
MB  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
Unit  
3
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
E
M
E
M
EA  
EB  
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
A
PG  
ESC  
ESCG  
MA  
MB  
A and B are the transmit and receive pairs, where:  
Note:  
TA = Transmit Tip, and RA = Receive Tip  
TB = Transmit Ring, and RB = Receive Ring  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 259 of 332  
NT6D70 SILC and NT6D71 UILC cards  
Refer to ISDN BRI Administration and Maintenance Guide (553-3011-311)  
for a complete description of trunk DSL installation and connections.  
Trunk connections (Europe)  
E&M TIE trunk card (2-Wire)  
Note: Refer to the Intelligent Peripheral Equipment Supplements for a  
complete description of European circuit cards.  
Table 60  
E&M TIE trunk card (2-wire)  
Column 3  
Type  
5(BPO)  
Cables Card 1 through  
Card 10 from chassis  
Column 1  
Paging  
Column 2  
Paging  
Pair  
Color  
Unit #  
Pins  
Lead Designations  
1T  
1R  
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
Unit 0  
2T  
2R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
29  
4
A
PG  
SIGB  
SIGA  
E
M
3T  
3R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
4T  
4R  
R-G  
G-R  
33  
8
A
PG  
SIGB  
SIGA  
E
M
5T  
5R  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
6T  
6R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
37  
12  
A
PG  
SIGB  
SIGA  
E
M
7T  
7R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
8T  
8R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
41  
16  
A
PG  
SIGB  
SIGA  
E
M
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Page 260 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Table 61  
E&M 2-wire Type 2  
Lead designations  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
E1  
E2  
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
Unit  
0
M1  
M2  
29  
4
W-G  
G-W  
T1  
R1  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
E1  
E2  
32  
7
R-O  
O-R  
Unit  
1
M1  
M2  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T2  
R2  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
E1  
E2  
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
Unit  
2
M1  
M2  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
T3  
R3  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
E1  
E2  
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Unit  
3
M1  
M2  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 261 of 332  
E&M TIE trunk card (4-Wire)  
Table 62  
E&M TIE trunk card (4-wire)  
Cables Card 1 through  
Card 10 from chassis  
Column 1  
Type 1 & 5  
Column 2  
Type 1 & 5  
Pair  
Color  
Unit #  
Pins  
Lead Designations  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
RA  
RB  
TA  
TB  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
TA  
TB  
RA  
RB  
Unit  
0
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
28  
3
E
M
E
M
4T  
4R  
W-S  
S-W  
30  
5
RA  
RB  
TA  
TB  
5T  
5R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
TA  
TB  
RA  
RB  
Unit  
1
6T  
6R  
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
E
M
E
M
7T  
7R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
34  
9
RA  
RB  
TA  
TB  
8T  
8R  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
TA  
TB  
RA  
RB  
Unit  
2
9T  
9R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
E
M
E
M
10T  
10R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
38  
13  
RA  
RB  
TA  
TB  
11T  
11R  
BK-BR-  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
TA  
TB  
RA  
RB  
Unit  
3
12T  
12R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
40  
15  
E
M
E
M
The cable pair designated TA, TB is the transmit pair. The pair designated  
Note:  
RA, RB is the receive pair.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 262 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Table 63  
E&M TIE trunk card (4-wire)  
Cables Card 1 through  
Card 10 from chassis  
Column 1  
Type 2  
Column 2  
Type 2  
Unit  
#
Pair  
Color  
Pins  
Lead Designations  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
Unit  
0
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
28  
3
E1  
E2  
E
M
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
29  
4
M1  
M2  
SIG0A  
SIG0B  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
30  
5
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
Unit  
1
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
E1  
E2  
E
M
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
33  
8
M1  
M2  
SIG1A  
SIG1B  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
34  
9
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
Unit  
2
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
E1  
E2  
E
M
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
37  
12  
M1  
M2  
SIG2A  
SIG2B  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 263 of 332  
Table 63  
E&M TIE trunk card (4-wire) (Continued)  
Cables Card 1 through  
Card 10 from chassis  
Column 1  
Type 2  
Column 2  
Type 2  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
38  
13  
RA  
RB  
RA  
RB  
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
TA  
TB  
TA  
TB  
Unit  
3
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
40  
15  
E1  
E2  
E
M
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
41  
16  
M1  
M2  
SIG3A  
SIG3B  
The cable pair designated TA, TB is the transmit pair. The pair designated  
Note:  
RA, RB is the receive pair.  
E&M TIE trunk card (2280Hz)  
Table 64  
E&M 2280 Hz TIE trunk connections  
Lead designations  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
TA  
TB  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
RA  
RB  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
TA  
TB  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
Unit 1  
RA  
RB  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
TA  
TB  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
RA  
RB  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
TA  
TB  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
RA  
RB  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 264 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
E&M TIE trunk card (RAN)  
Table 65  
E&M 2-wire Recorded Announcement trunk connections  
Lead designations  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
SIG B  
SIG A  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
T1  
R1  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
SIG B  
SIG A  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T2  
R2  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
SIG B  
SIG A  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
T3  
R3  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
SIG B  
SIG A  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
E&M TIE trunk card (MUS)  
Table 66  
E&M 2-wire Music trunk connections  
Lead designations  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit  
0
T1  
R1  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
Unit  
1
T2  
R2  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
Unit  
2
T3  
R3  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
Unit  
3
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 265 of 332  
CO & DID trunk card  
Table 67  
Central Office & Direct Inward Dial trunk connections  
Cable from chassis  
Column 1  
Column 2  
Column 3  
Pair  
Color  
Pins  
Lead designations  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
T0  
R0  
T0  
R0  
A0  
B0  
Unit 0  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
Unit 4  
Unit 5  
Unit 6  
Unit 7  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
PPM0  
C0  
Spare  
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
28  
3
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
A1  
B1  
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
29  
4
PPM1  
C1  
Spare  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
30  
5
T2  
R2  
T2  
R2  
A2  
B2  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
PPM2  
C2  
Spare  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
T3  
R3  
T3  
R3  
A3  
B3  
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
33  
8
PPM3  
C3  
Spare  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
34  
9
T4  
R4  
T4  
R4  
A4  
B4  
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
PPM4  
C4  
Spare  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
T5  
R5  
T5  
R5  
A5  
B5  
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
37  
12  
PPM5  
C5  
Spare  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
38  
13  
T6  
R6  
T6  
R6  
A6  
B6  
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
PPM6  
C6  
Spare  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
40  
15  
T7  
R7  
T7  
R7  
A7  
B7  
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
41  
16  
PPM7  
C7  
Spare  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 266 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Central Office trunk card  
Table 68  
Central Office trunk connections  
Cable from chassis  
Pair  
Color  
Pins  
Lead designations  
1T  
1R  
W-BL  
BL-W  
26  
1
T0  
R0  
2T  
2R  
W-O  
O-W  
27  
2
Unit 0  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
3T  
3R  
W-G  
G-W  
28  
3
4T  
4R  
W-BR  
BR-W  
29  
4
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
30  
5
T1  
R1  
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
31  
6
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
32  
7
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
33  
8
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
34  
9
T2  
R2  
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
35  
10  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
36  
11  
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
37  
12  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
38  
13  
T3  
R3  
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
39  
14  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
40  
15  
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
41  
16  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 267 of 332  
Trunk connections (UK)  
NT5K17 Direct Inward Dial card terminations  
Cross connect the NT5K17 DDI card as follows:  
Table 69  
NT5K17 DDI cross-connect terminations  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
T1  
R1  
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
Unit 4  
Unit 5  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
T2  
R2  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
T3  
R3  
32  
7
R-O  
O-R  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T4  
R4  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
T5  
R5  
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 268 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Table 69  
NT5K17 DDI cross-connect terminations (Continued)  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T6  
R6  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
Unit 6  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
T7  
R7  
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Unit 7  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card terminations  
Cross connect the NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card as shown in Table 70.  
Note: The connections on the NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card are  
polarity sensitive. Make sure the ground side of the trunk is connected to  
the A leg of the NT5K18 circuit. Make sure the -50 volt side of the trunk  
is connected to the B leg of the NT5K18 circuit.  
Table 70  
NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card cross-connect terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
T1  
R1  
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
T2  
R2  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 269 of 332  
Table 70  
NT5K18 Exchange line trunk card cross-connect terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
T3  
R3  
32  
7
R-O  
O-R  
Unit 3  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T4  
R4  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
Unit 4  
Unit 5  
Unit 6  
Unit 7  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
T5  
R5  
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
T6  
R6  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
T7  
R7  
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 270 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
NT5K19 Analog TIE line trunk card terminations  
Cross connect the NT5K19 analog TIE line trunk card as shown in Table 71.  
Note: The speech pairs on the NT5K19 card are polarity insensitive. The  
E&M signalling pairs, however, are polarity sensitive. Make sure the  
ground side of the trunk is connected to the A leg of the NT5K19 circuit.  
Make sure the -50 volt side of the trunk is connected to the B leg.  
Table 71  
NT5K19 2W paging mode terminations  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair color  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
Unit 0  
A
PG  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
T1  
R1  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
A
PG  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T2  
R2  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
A
PG  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
T3  
R3  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
A
PG  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 271 of 332  
Table 72  
NT5K19 2W Type 1 mode terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
Unit 0  
E
M
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
T1  
R1  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
E
M
32  
&
R-O  
O-R  
T2  
R2  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
E
M
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
T3  
R3  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
E
M
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 272 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Table 73  
NT5K19 4W Type 1 mode terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
TA  
TB  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
RA  
RB  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
Unit 0  
E
M
28  
3
W-G  
G-W  
RA  
RB  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
TA  
RB  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
E
M
32  
7
R-O  
O-R  
TA  
TB  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
RA  
RB  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
E
M
36  
11  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
TA  
TB  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
RA  
TB  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
E
M
40  
15  
BK-S  
S-BK  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 273 of 332  
Table 74  
NT5K19 AC15 mode pair terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
TA  
TB  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
RA  
RB  
27  
2
W-O  
O-W  
TA  
TB  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
RA  
RB  
31  
6
R-BL  
BL-R  
TA  
TB  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
RA  
RB  
35  
10  
R-S  
S-R  
TA  
TB  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
RA  
TB  
39  
14  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 274 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
Table 75  
NT5K19 Recorded announcement mode pair terminations  
color  
Pair  
Pins  
Pair  
Unit number  
T0  
R0  
26  
1
W-BL  
BL-W  
Unit 0  
SIG B  
SIG A  
29  
4
W-BR  
BR-W  
T1  
R1  
30  
5
W-S  
S-W  
Unit 1  
Unit 2  
Unit 3  
SIG B  
SIG A  
33  
8
R-G  
G-R  
T2  
R2  
34  
9
R-BR  
BR-R  
SIG B  
SIG A  
37  
12  
BK-O  
O-BK  
T3  
R3  
38  
13  
BK-G  
G-BK  
SIG B  
SIG A  
41  
16  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Activating a default model trunk  
Due to the automatic 30 second time-out on the administration menu, prepare  
the data that you want to input before you begin. To determine the  
corresponding TNs and trunks, check the location of trunk cards in the chassis  
or use LD 32.  
INSTRUCTIONS FOR THE UK  
Refer to the Meridian 1 Guide for the UK (553-3001-110) for a list of  
the default trunk models and trunk routes used in the UK.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 275 of 332  
Procedure 41  
Activating a default model trunk  
1
2
Lift the handset of the administration telephone.  
Enter the administration Flexible Feature Code to access the  
administration menu.  
The prompt “PASSWORD?” appears.  
3
Enter the default administration telephone password.  
You hear special dial tone and the prompt  
“TASK?” appears in the top line of the character display.  
The second line of the display reads”1 ADD TRUNK”.  
Select “1 ADD TRUNK” by entering the number “1”.  
The prompt “ROUTE ACCESS?” appears on the character display.  
4
5
Enter the access code of the route to which you want to add a  
trunk and press the pound key (#).  
The prompt  
“TN?” asks you to enter a TN (Terminal Number) from one of the  
installed trunk cards.  
If you do not enter a valid route number, “TN?” does not appear and  
the screen remains the same. If the type of trunk card does not match  
the route, the prompt “ROUTE ACCESS?” appears again, and you  
hear overflow tone.  
6
7
Enter the TN in Option 11 format (CCUU) and press the pound  
key.  
The prompt  
“MODEL” appears. If you enter an invalid TN, the display shows  
“INVALID, TN?” and you must enter a new TN using the Option 11  
format.  
Press the digits to select a trunk model (as assigned in LD 16).  
The character display shows  
“OK”.  
After a delay of approximately four seconds, you hear special dial tone.  
The sequence repeats when the prompt  
“TN?” appears on the character display.  
The next valid trunk TN automatically increments after each trunk is  
activated.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 276 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
8
Terminate the sequence by hanging up the telephone receiver.  
OR  
Repeat the sequence by going through the steps again.  
When you enter “#” when the procedure repeats, you accept the next  
TN and are prompted for the model type.  
When you enter “#” again, you accept the previously accepted model.  
Note: The model selected during the first trunk activation sequence is  
the default model for all subsequent trunks. This is the case until you  
hang up the telephone or manually enter a new trunk model number.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Activating a selected model trunk  
Due to the automatic 30 second time-out on the administration menu, prepare  
the data that you want to input before you begin. To determine the  
corresponding TNs and trunks, check the location of trunk cards in the chassis  
or use LD 32.  
Procedure 42  
Activating a selected model trunk  
1
2
Lift the handset of the administration telephone.  
Enter the administration Flexible Feature Code to access the  
administration menu.  
3
Enter the default administration telephone password.  
You hear special dial tone and the prompt “TASK?” appears on the top  
line of the character display. The second line of the character display  
reads “1 ADD TRUNK”.  
4
5
Select “1 ADD TRUNK” by entering the number “1”.  
The prompt  
“ROUTE ACCESS?” appears.  
Enter the access code of the configured trunk route to which you  
want to add the trunk and press the pound key (#).  
The prompt  
“TN?” asks you to enter a TN from one of the installed trunk cards. If  
you do not enter a valid route number, “TN?” does not appear and the  
screen remains the same. If the card does not match the route, the  
prompt “ROUTE ACCESS?” appears again, and you hear overflow  
tone.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks Page 277 of 332  
6
7
Enter the TN in Option 11 format (CCUU).  
The response  
“MODEL?”  
prompts you to select a model number for the trunk.  
Enter a trunk model number for the specified TN, and route and  
press the pound key (#).  
The character display shows:  
“OK”  
After a delay of approximately four seconds, you hear special dial tone.  
The sequence is repeated when the following prompt appears on the  
character display.  
“TN?”  
8
Hang up or repeat the sequence.  
The sequence ends when the last unit in the card is used and the  
program is complete, or when you hang up the telephone receiver.  
Note: The model used for the first trunk activated in the sequence will  
be the default for all subsequent trunks. This is the case until you hang  
up or you manually enter a new trunk model number.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 278 of 332  
Chapter 18 — Connecting the trunks  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
284  
Page 279 of 332  
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external  
alarm  
This chapter describes the procedures for connecting an external alarm to the  
Option 11C Mini system. This chapter contains the following procedure:  
Procedure 43: “Installing an alarm using an alarm port” on page 279  
The following are the two methods of connecting an external alarm to the  
Option 11C Mini system:  
through an alarm port assigned in software  
through contacts in a QUA6 Power Failure Transfer Unit (PFTU)  
Alarm port assigned in software  
You can equip the system with an alarm port. Connect an analog line to an  
device.  
Procedure 43  
Installing an alarm using an alarm port  
1
Install an analog (500/2500 type) line as described in “Chapter 17  
— Connecting the telephones” on page 229.  
2
Connect an analog (500/2500 type) telephone, or another similar  
alerting device used as an alarm, to the line.  
You can assign the set as Model 20.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Page 280 of 332  
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external alarm  
3
Use LD 15 and make the following changes.  
Note: The following list only contains the prompts requiring a  
response. Use a Carriage Return, <CR>, to accept the default values  
for the other prompts.  
a) Enter CHG in response to the REQ prompt.  
b) Enter CDB in response to the TYPE prompt.  
c) Enter the customer number (0-99) in response to the CUST  
prompt.  
d) Enter the DN ofthelineassigned asanalarmport in response to  
the ALDN prompt.  
Note: If the DN assigned to the alarm is accidentally called, the alarm  
activates. To avoid false alarms, make sure the DN is not consistent  
with the assigned numbering.  
e) Press return in response to the remaining prompts.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Alarm through a QUA6 PFTU  
A QUA6 PFTU can be used to connect an external alarm through normally  
open or normally closed contacts of one of its units. The contacts operate  
under the same conditions as the PFTU, and can support the capacities listed  
in Table 76.  
Table 76  
AC capacities  
AC capacities  
Maximum switching power  
Maximum switching voltage  
Maximum switching current  
125.0 V rms  
0.5 A  
Figure 70 on page 281 shows an example of the contacts on one unit (PFT1)  
of the PFTU. Figure 70 shows the contacts in normal operating mode, not in  
failure mode. Table 77 on page 282 provides the connections for all units on  
the PFTU.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external alarm Page 281 of 332  
Figure 70  
Contacts in PFTU  
PFT 1 on PFTU  
8T (R-G)  
Normally  
connected  
to a  
7T (R-O)  
Normally  
connected  
to a  
trunk line card  
8R (G-R)  
CO trunk  
7R (O-R)  
5T (W-S)  
6T (R-BL)  
Normally  
connected  
to a  
Normally  
connected  
to a  
telephone line card  
6R (BL-R)  
telephone  
5R (S-W)  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 282 of 332  
Table 77  
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external alarm  
Power Failure Transfer Unit connections  
Unit  
Pair  
Color  
Normal mode  
Failure mode  
5T  
5R  
W-S  
S-W  
Makes with 6T  
and 6R  
Opens 6T and 6R  
Makes with 7T and 7R  
P
F
T
6T  
6R  
R-BL  
BL-R  
Makes with 5T  
and 5R  
Open  
7T  
7R  
R-O  
O-R  
Makes with 8T  
and 8R  
Opens 8T and 8R  
Makes with 5T and 5R  
1
8T  
8R  
R-G  
G-R  
Makes with 7T  
and 7R  
Open  
9T  
9R  
R-BR  
BR-R  
Makes with 10T  
and 10R  
Opens 10T and 10R  
Makes with 11T and 11R  
P
F
T
10T  
10R  
R-S  
S-R  
Makes with 9T  
and 9R  
Open  
11T  
11R  
BK-BL  
BL-BK  
Makes with 12T  
and 12R  
Opens 12T and 12R  
Makes with 9T and 9R  
2
12T  
12R  
BK-O  
O-BK  
Makes with 11T  
and 11R  
Open  
13T  
13R  
BK-G  
G-BK  
Makes with 14T  
and 14R  
Opens 14T and 14R  
Makes with 15T and 15R  
P
F
T
14T  
14R  
BK-BR  
BR-BK  
Makes with 13T  
and 13R  
Open  
15T  
15R  
BK-S  
S-BK  
Makes with 16T  
and 16R  
Opens 16T and 16R  
Makes with 13T and 13R  
3
16T  
16R  
Y-BL  
BL-Y  
Makes with 15T  
and 15R  
Open  
17T  
17R  
Y- O  
O-Y  
Makes with 18T  
and 18R  
Opens 18T and 18R  
Makes with 19T and 19R  
P
F
T
18T  
18R  
Y- G  
G-Y  
Makes with 17T  
and 17R  
Open  
19T  
19R  
Y-BR  
BR-Y  
Makes with 20T  
and 20R  
Opens 20T and 20R  
Makes with 17T and 17R  
4
20T  
20R  
Y- S  
S-Y  
Makes with 19T  
and 19R  
Open  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external alarm Page 283 of 332  
21T  
21R  
V-BL  
BL-V  
Makes with 22T  
and 22R  
Opens 22T and 22R  
Makes with 23T and 23R  
P
F
T
22T  
22R  
V-O  
O-V  
Makes with 21T  
and 21R  
Open  
23T  
23R  
V-G  
G-V  
Makes with 24T  
and 24R  
Opens 24T and 24R  
Makes with 21T and 21R  
5
24T  
24R  
V-BR  
BR-V  
Makes with 23T  
and 23R  
Open  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 284 of 332  
Chapter 19 — Connecting an external alarm  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
314  
Page 285 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
When you first install an Option 11C Mini system, you must enter customer  
data into the overlay programs. You must, for example, assign features to  
telephone keys for the telephones to work correctly.  
Nortel Networks or its distributors can program the Mini System Controller  
(MSC) card with customer data before they send the card to the customer site.  
If you load preprogrammed data into the system during the installation  
process, some overlay entries configure automatically on the telephones. For  
example, you can select a telephone model that has feature and key  
assignments already determined and a Class of Service already assigned. If  
you have to program several types of telephone models, an MSC card with  
preprogrammed data can save you time.  
For software installation, the MSC card does not have to have data  
programmed in advance. The MSC card can be programmed with the  
minimum number of files to allow the Option 11C Mini to operate.  
This chapter contains information about the following:  
Passwords and codes  
Default numbering plan  
Flexible Feature Codes  
SDI ports  
Trunk routes and models  
Model telephones  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 286 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Passwords and codes  
Table 78 lists each function in the left column with its password or code on  
the right.  
Table 78  
Passwords and codes  
Function  
Code or extension(s)  
TTY password  
0000  
(For access to TTY Option 11C Mini overlays)  
Meridian Mail Mini administration password  
Administration telephone password  
adminpwd  
1234  
Administration telephone FFC  
*41  
1
SPRE code  
Telephone relocation Flexible Feature Code  
Telephone Removal Flexible Feature Code  
Telephone relocation password (SCRD)  
*40  
*42  
1234  
Default numbering plan  
The default numbering plan for Option 11C Mini is based on the following  
guidelines:  
The default numbering plan uses four digits and starts at 2200.  
The prime extension number (DN) for each telephone is in the range  
2200-2XXX. The value of “XXX” varies depending on the number of  
telephones that you have in the system. Any secondary extension  
numbers use numbers outside this range. This arrangement allows the  
Option 11C Mini and Meridian Mail Mini to automatically configure  
telephones and their mailboxes.  
Meridian Mail Mini uses extension 7000 for access, 7001 for Auto  
Attendant, 7002 for Express Messaging, and 7003 for Prompt  
Maintenance.  
Meridian Mail Mini Virtual Agents are preconfigured for card slot 10 in  
Units 0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, and 13 of the Chassis Expander.  
The Central Answering Position has an extension of 7700. You can  
change this extension in LD 15.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 287 of 332  
First digits  
Table 79 shows the default numbering plan for Option 11C Mini:  
Table 79  
Default numbering plan—First digit  
First digit  
Preprogrammed use for digit  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
SPRE code  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
COT/TIE/DID/WATS/FEX/RAN/MUS/AWR/Paging  
Trunk access codes, Meridian Mail Mini queues and  
attendant DN, Call park DNs  
8
9
0
Not used  
Not used  
Attendant extension  
Note: The first number of the default numbering plan is preprogrammed  
as 2200. The remaining numbers in the default numbering plan are  
assigned in software. These numbers do not become active, however,  
until you select the numbers during the telephone activation procedure.  
The digit “7” in the default numbering plan is programmed with many system  
features to help you in configuring the Option 11C Mini system. If you have  
the Meridian Mail Mini software, it automatically configures user mailboxes  
to correspond with the 2200 numbering plan. The preprogrammed Meridian  
Mail Mini queues in the Meridian Mail Mini software match the default data  
on the Option 11C system.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 288 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Important extension numbers  
Table 80  
Default numbering plan—important extension numbers  
Extension  
Use  
Attendant extension  
0
First number in numbering plan  
Night number  
2200  
7700*  
7700 *  
7750 *  
Queue for Central Answering Position  
General ACD queue  
Meridian Mail Mini miscellaneous ACD  
queues:  
Meridian Mail Mini extension  
Auto attendant extension  
Express messaging  
7000-7009  
7000  
7001  
7002  
Prompt maintenance  
Miscellaneous queues  
7003  
7004-7009  
Meridian Mail Mini position ID  
Meridian Mail Mini agent extensions  
Call park extensions  
7800-7811  
7830-7841  
7900-7919  
* The thresholds which control the agent AWC keys have been set as follows:  
CWTH 1  
CWLF 2  
CWLW 4  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 289 of 332  
Extensions assigned to card slots  
Table 81  
Extensions assigned to card slots in the Main Chassis and Chassis  
Expander  
Slot number  
Card number  
Main Chassis  
Extension numbers  
1
2
3
4
4
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
2200 through 2215  
2216 through 2231  
2232 through 2247  
2248 through 2263  
2264 through 2279  
2280 through 2295  
Chassis Expander  
7
8
7
8
2296 through 2311  
2312 through 2327  
2328 through 2343  
2344 through 2359  
9
9
10  
10  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 290 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Flexible Feature Codes  
Many administrative procedures use Flexible Feature Code (FFC) data.  
Table 82 lists the FFCs for the Option 11C Mini system.  
Table 82  
Flexible Feature Codes  
FFC Prompt  
FFC  
Definition  
ASRC  
AREM  
ADMN  
CFWA  
CFWD  
C6DS  
HOLD  
MNTC  
PUGR  
RDLN  
RDST  
RGAA  
RGAD  
RGAV  
SPCC  
SPCU  
SSPU  
*40  
*42  
*41  
#1  
Automatic Set Relocation  
Automatic Set Removal Code  
Administration Set Access Code  
Call Forward All Calls Activate  
Call Forward All Calls Deactivate  
6 Party Conference Code  
Permanent Call Hold  
#1  
*70  
#4  
*43  
*71  
*72  
*73  
*74  
*75  
*77  
#2/*80  
#3/*81  
*89  
Maintenance Access Code  
Pick-up Group Code  
Last Number Redial  
Store Last Number Redial  
Ring Again Activate  
Ring Again Deactivate  
Ring Again Verify  
Speed Call Controller Code  
Speed Call User Code  
System Speed Call User Code  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 291 of 332  
SDI ports  
The minimum system port configuration for Option 11C Mini is 3 SDI ports,  
all of which are on the NTDK97 MSC card.  
You can get additional ports by installing an NTAK02 SDI/DCH circuit card.  
The SDI/DCH card has 4 serial I/O ports with three possible configurations:  
2 asynchronous ESDI ports with 2 DCHI ports  
2 synchronous ESDI ports  
2 SDI ports  
Table 83 shows the default SDI port configuration. The value for “XX” is set  
on the faceplate of the MSC circuit card.  
Table 83  
Preconfigured SDI ports  
TTY Number  
Card  
Port  
Use  
Configuration  
0
1
2
8
9
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
MTC/SCH/BUG XX/8/1/NONE  
MTC/SCH/BUG 1200/8/1/NONE  
MTC/SCH/BUG 1200/8/1/NONE  
0
10  
10  
LSL  
1200/8/1/NONE  
4800  
CMS  
Modem port  
The preconfigured modem port allows the remote maintenance modem to be  
connected without additional system programming. This port is  
preconfigured as TTY 0 (port 0 on the MSC card) and is programmed for  
Maintenance (MTC), Service Change (SCH), and BUG messages.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 292 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Enhanced Serial Data Interface (ESDI) port  
Port 9 is preprogrammed as an ESDI port and supports Meridian Mail Mini.  
It functions as a Command Status Link with the following settings:  
ESDI settings  
Table 84  
ESDI settings  
Setting  
Code  
BPS  
CLOK  
IADR  
RADR  
T1  
4800  
EXT  
003  
001  
10  
T2  
002  
040  
128  
08  
T3  
N1  
N2  
K
7
RXMT  
CRC  
ORUR  
ABOR  
USER  
ENL  
05  
10  
005  
005  
CMS  
NO  
Telephone tones  
The telephone tones in North America are as follows:  
Dial tone: A continuous tone  
Special dial tone: Three beeps followed by continuous dial tone.  
Overflow tone: Like a busy tone, except faster and higher.  
Relocation tone: A short high-pitched beep that continues for 4 seconds,  
followed by silence.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 293 of 332  
Trunk routes  
Table 85 shows preprogrammed trunk route information that you must have  
on hand to activate and modify trunks.  
Table 85  
Preprogrammed trunk route information  
Access  
Route  
Type  
Code  
Mode  
Interface  
00 *  
01 *  
02 *  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
50  
51  
52  
COT  
COT  
COT  
TIE  
7100  
7101  
7102  
7103  
7104  
7105  
7106  
7107  
7108  
7109  
7140  
7141  
7142  
7143  
7144  
7150  
7151  
7152  
IAO  
ICT  
OGT  
IAO  
ICT  
OGT  
ICT  
IAO  
ICT  
OGT  
OGT  
-
-
-
-
-
TIE  
-
TIE  
-
DID  
-
WAT  
WAT  
WAT  
MUS  
AWR  
RAN  
RAN  
PAG  
FEX  
FEX  
FEX  
-
-
-
-
AUD  
-
DGT  
-
AUD  
OGT  
IAO  
ICT  
OGT  
-
-
-
-
Note: Trunk routes marked with an asterisk (*) are configured to support  
Call Detail Recording (CDR) output. CDR is preconfigured as follows:  
CDR  
INC  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
OAL  
AIA  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 294 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Trunk models  
Note: All trunks are programmed as immediate start/supervision = Yes,  
with the exception of trunks with an asterisk (*) next to them. Trunks  
marked with an asterisk (*) are set for wink start/supervision = Yes.  
Table 86  
Trunk model information  
DIP or  
DTN  
BIMP and  
TIMP  
Mode  
Pack  
Model  
Signaling  
COT  
XUT  
1
2
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
EAM  
EM4  
EAM  
DIP  
DIP  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
- /600  
3
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
4
5
6
DIP  
7
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
8
TIE  
XUT  
1
2
DIP  
3
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
4
5
6
DIP  
7
DTN  
DIP  
8
XEM  
16  
17  
18  
DIP  
DIP  
-
DTN  
- / 600  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 295 of 332  
Table 86  
Trunk model information (Continued)  
DIP or  
DTN  
BIMP and  
TIMP  
Mode  
Pack  
Model  
Signaling  
19  
1
EM4  
DIP  
DIP  
-
DID  
XUT  
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
3COM/600  
2
3
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
DTN  
DIP  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
4
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
DTN  
DIP  
5*  
6*  
7*  
8*  
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
DTN  
DIP  
LDR  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
LDR  
DTN  
(Wink Start  
Supv = Yes  
WAT  
XUT  
1
2
3
4
5
6
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
DIP  
DIP  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
DIP  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 296 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Table 86  
Trunk model information (Continued)  
DIP or  
DTN  
BIMP and  
TIMP  
Mode  
Pack  
Model  
Signaling  
7
8
GRD  
LOP  
DTN  
DTN  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/600  
600/1200  
600/1200  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
-/600  
MUS  
AWR  
RAN  
PAG  
XUT  
XUT  
XUT  
XUT  
1
1
1
1
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
LDR  
OAD  
EAM  
EM4  
EAM  
EM4  
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
GRD  
LOP  
DIP  
DIP  
2
3
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
4
5
6
DIP  
7
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
8
XEM  
XUT  
16  
17  
18  
19  
1
DIP  
-
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
- /600  
-
FEX  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/600  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
2
DIP  
3
DTN  
DTN  
DIP  
4
5
6
DIP  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 297 of 332  
Table 86  
Trunk model information (Continued)  
DIP or  
DTN  
BIMP and  
TIMP  
Mode  
Pack  
Model  
Signaling  
7
8
GRD  
LOP  
DTN  
DTN  
3COM/900  
3COM/900  
* These trunks are set for Wink start.  
Model telephones  
This section provides a series of tables that list the different model telephones,  
their intended use, assigned Class of Service options, and key number  
positions with assigned features.  
Refer to the following tables:  
Table 93, “Analog (500/2500-type) telephone models,” on page 303  
Table 94, “M2006 General business telephone models,” on page 304  
Table 95, “M2008 General business telephone models,” on page 305  
Table 96, “M2008 Two-line general business telephone models,” on  
page 306  
Table 100, “M2616 Secretary telephone models,” on page 311  
Table 101, “M2616 ACD telephone models,” on page 312  
Table 102, “M2616 Manager telephone models,” on page 313  
Table 103, “M2616 Message center telephone models,” on page 314  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 298 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Note: Off-premises Station (OPS) telephones do not have their own  
telephone models. You can, however, create OPS models by entering DD  
in response to the CDEN prompt in LD 10.  
Tables 87 through 89 show the acronyms for the Class of Service options for  
each telephone model in this section.  
Table 87  
Class of Service options - analog (500/2500-type) telephones  
Prompt  
Meaning  
TLD  
HTA  
Toll Denied  
Hunting Allowed  
LNA  
FNA  
PUA  
XRA  
MWA  
Last Number Redial Allowed  
Call Forward No Answer Allowed  
Pickup Allowed  
Ring Again Allowed  
Message Waiting Allowed  
Table 88  
Class of Service options - Meridian 1 digital telephones  
Prompt  
Meaning  
TLD  
AAD  
ADD  
HTA  
Toll Denied  
Automatic Answerback Denied  
Automatic Digit Display  
Hunting Allowed  
LNA  
FNA  
PUA  
XRA  
MWA  
Last Number Redial Allowed  
Call Forward No Answer Allowed  
Pickup Allowed  
Ring Again Allowed  
Message Waiting Allowed  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 299 of 332  
Table 89  
Class of Service options - ACD telephones  
Prompt  
Meaning  
UNR  
AAD  
ADD  
HTA  
Unrestricted  
Automatic Answerback Denied  
Automatic Digit Display  
Hunting Allowed  
LNA  
FND  
PUD  
MWA  
Last Number Redial Allowed  
Call Forward No Answer Allowed  
Pickup Denied  
Message Waiting Allowed  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 300 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Administration telephone models  
M2008 model 99  
Intended use: Administration (maintenance) telephone  
Assigned Class of Service options:  
MTA/ADD/LNA/FNA/GPUA/MWA/FBD  
Table 90  
M2008 telephone model 99  
Key number  
Feature  
position  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Blank  
Message  
Transfer  
Speed Call (personnel: 99)  
Forward  
Conference  
DN  
DN  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 301 of 332  
M2616 model 99  
Intended use: Administration (maintenance) telephone  
Assigned Class of Service options:  
MTA/LNA/FNA/GPUA/MWA/ADD//HFA/FBD  
Table 91  
M2616 model 99 telephone  
Key  
Key  
Feature  
number number Feature  
position position  
-
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
Autodial  
Autodial  
Autodial  
Autodial  
Autodial  
Autodial  
Speed Call  
Message  
Transfer  
Ring Again  
Forward  
Conference  
DN  
(personnel: 99)  
8
DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 302 of 332  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
Central Answering Position (CAP) telephone models  
M2616 and M2216 CAP telephone model 60  
Intended use: Central Answering Position telephone  
Assigned Class of Service options:  
LNA/FND/GPUA/MWA/ADD/HFD/AGN/FBD/SPV  
Table 92  
M2616 and M2216 telephone model 60  
Key  
Key  
number number  
Feature  
Feature  
positio  
n
positio  
n
Hot *  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
Make Set Busy  
Display Waiting Calls  
Autodial  
DN  
Park  
Override  
Add  
Autodial  
Autodial  
Consult/Join  
Extend  
Autodial  
Autodial  
8
ACD Queue (7700)  
* This key is used as a Hotline to connect to the office paging system. Assign  
it with the paging route access code and define it when you activate the  
telephone.  
Note: With the M2616 CAP, you must use an ACD character display. In  
the system software, the Extend key is called a Transfer key. The  
Consult/Join key is called a Conference key. The Add key is called a No  
Hold Conference key.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 303 of 332  
Analog (500/2500-type) telephone models  
Note: When you are activating an analog (500-type) telephone, you  
must use an analog (2500-type) telephone to define the features. When  
you have done this, disconnect the analog (2500-type) telephone and  
replace it with the analog (500-type) telephone that you are activating.  
Analog (500/2500-type) support personnel telephone models  
Table 93  
Analog (500/2500-type) telephone models  
Model  
Type of telephone  
Assigned Class of Service options  
20  
Support personnel telephone  
with toll denied  
TLD, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FND, GPUA, LNA, XFA,  
XRA, FBD  
21  
22  
23  
24  
Support personnel telephone  
UNR, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FND, GPUA, LNA,  
XFA, XRA, FBD  
Support personnel telephone  
with message indication lamp  
MWA, TLD, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FNA, GPUA,  
LNA, XFA, XRA, FBD, LPA  
Support personnel telephone  
with message indication lamp  
MWA, UNR, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FNA, GPUA,  
LNA, XFA, XRA, FBD, LPA  
Support personnel telephone  
with message indication and no  
lamp  
MWA, TLD, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FNA, GPUA,  
LNA, XFA, XRA, FBD, LPD  
25  
26  
Support personnel telephone  
with message indication and no  
lamp  
MWA, UNR, C6A, CFXD, DTN, FNA, GPUA,  
LNA, XFA, XRA, FBD, LPD  
Courtesy telephone  
MNL, TLD  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 304 of 332  
Table 94  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2006 General business telephone models  
M2006 General business telephone models  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
20  
General business  
telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, UNR  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1- Conference  
0 - DN  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
General business  
telephone with message  
indicator  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, UNR  
5 - Message  
4 - Transfer  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone with message  
indication and speed call  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, UNR  
5 - Message  
4 - Speed Call  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, TLD  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone with message  
indicator  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, TLD  
5 - Message  
4 - Transfer  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone with message  
indication and speed call  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, FBD, TLD  
5 - Message  
4 - Speed Call  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 305 of 332  
M2008 General business telephone models  
Table 95  
M2008 General business telephone models  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
20  
General business  
telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Autodial  
6 - Autodial  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
21  
22  
23  
General business  
telephone with message  
indication  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Autodial  
6 - Message  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone with display  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Autodial  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
General business  
telephone with message  
indication and display  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Message  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Pick-up  
2 - Forward  
1 - Conference  
0 - DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 306 of 332  
Table 96  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2008 Two-line general business telephone models  
M2008 Two-line general business telephone models  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
24  
Two-line general  
business telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Autodial  
6 - Transfer  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
25  
26  
27  
Two-line general  
business telephone with  
message indication  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Autodial  
6 - Message  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Two-line general  
business telephone with  
display  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Transfer  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Two-line general  
business telephone with  
message indication and  
display  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Message  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 307 of 332  
Table 96  
M2008 Two-line general business telephone models (Continued)  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
28  
Two-line general  
business telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Autodial  
6 - Autodial  
5 - Autodial  
4 - Autodial  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Page 308 of 332  
Table 97  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2008 manager telephone models  
M2008 Manager telephone models  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
30  
Manager telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Transfer  
6 - Voice Call  
5 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
31  
32  
33  
Manager telephone with  
message indication  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7 - Voice Call  
6 - Message  
5 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Manager telephone with  
display  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Voice Call  
5 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Manager telephone with  
message indication and  
display  
FNA, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7 -  
6 - Message  
5 - Voice Call  
4 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 309 of 332  
M2008 Message center telephone models  
Table 98  
M2008 Message center telephone models  
Assigned Class of  
Service options  
Key number position with  
assigned feature  
Model  
Intended use  
60  
Message center  
telephone  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, NDD, FBD  
7- Message Cancellation  
6 - Message Indication  
5 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
4 - Ring Again  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
61  
Message center  
telephone with display  
FND, GPUA, LNA,  
MWA, ADD, FBD  
7-  
6 - Message Cancellation  
5 - Message Indication  
4 - Speed Call (personnel: 20)  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 310 of 332  
Table 99  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2216 ACD telephone models  
M2216 ACD telephone models  
Assigned  
Class of  
Service  
options  
Key number position with assigned  
feature  
Model  
Intended use  
20  
ACD agent with  
display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, FBD  
15 - Autodial  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - ACD calls  
waiting  
7 -  
6 - Transfer  
5 - Speed Call  
4 - Forward  
3 - Conference  
2 - Make Set Busy  
1 - Not ready  
0 - ACD DN (7750)  
8 - DN  
30  
ACD supervisor  
with display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, FBD  
15 - Autodial  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Display Agents  
9 - Display Queue  
8 - DN  
7 -  
6 - Transfer  
5 - Speed Call  
4 - Forward  
3 - Conference  
2 - Make Set Busy  
1 - Not Ready  
0 - ACD DN (7750)  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 311 of 332  
M2616 Secretary telephone models  
Table 100  
M2616 Secretary telephone models  
Assigned  
Class of  
Service  
options  
Key number position with assigned  
feature  
Model  
Intended use  
20  
Secretary  
telephone with  
display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
15 - Autodial  
14 - Autodial  
7 -  
6 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
5 - Transfer  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Autodial  
0 - DN  
21  
Secretary  
LNA, FNA,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFD, FBD  
15 - Autodial  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
7 -  
telephone with  
display and  
message  
6 - Message  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
indication  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Transfer  
0 - DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 312 of 332  
Table 101  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2616 Advanced business telephone  
M2616 ACD telephone models  
Assigned  
Class of  
Service  
options  
Key number position with assigned  
feature  
Model  
Intended use  
22  
Advanced  
business  
telephone  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
NDD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
7 - Transfer  
6 - Speed Call  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Autodial  
0 - DN  
23  
24  
25  
Advanced  
business  
telephone with  
message  
LNA, FNA,  
GPUA, MWA,  
NDD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
7 - Speed Call  
6 - Message  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Transfer  
indication  
0 - DN  
Advanced  
business  
telephone with  
display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
7 -  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Transfer  
6 - Speed Call  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Advanced  
business  
telephone with  
message  
indication and  
display  
LNA, FNA,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
7 -  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Transfer  
8 - Speed Call  
6 - Message  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data Page 313 of 332  
M2616 Manager telephone models  
Table 102  
M2616 Manager telephone models  
Assigned  
Class of  
Service  
options  
Key number position with assigned  
feature  
Model  
Intended use  
30  
Manager  
telephone  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
NDD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
14 - Autodial  
7 - Transfer  
6 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Autodial  
8 - Voice Call  
0 - DN  
31  
32  
33  
Manager  
telephone with  
message  
LNA, FNA,  
GPUA, MWA,  
NDD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
7 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
6 - Message  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Voice Call  
8 - Transfer  
indication  
0 - DN  
Manager  
telephone with  
display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
14 - Autodial  
7 -  
6 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Voice Call  
8 - Transfer  
0 - DN  
Manager  
LNA, FNA,  
15 -  
7 -  
telephone with  
message  
indication and  
display  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
14 - Autodial  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Voice Call  
9 - Transfer  
8 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
6 - Message  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 314 of 332  
Table 103  
Appendix A – Preprogrammed data  
M2616 Message center telephone models  
M2616 Message center telephone models  
Assigned  
Class of  
Service  
options  
Key number position with assigned  
feature  
Model  
Intended use  
61  
Message center  
telephone  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
NDD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
14 - Autodial  
7 - Transfer  
6 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
1 - DN  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Autodial  
9 - Message  
Cancellation  
8 - Message  
Indication  
0 - DN  
62  
Message center  
telephone with  
display  
LNA, FND,  
GPUA, MWA,  
ADD, HFA, FBD  
15 -  
14 - Autodial  
7 -  
6 - Speed Call  
(personnel: 20)  
5 - Ring Again  
4 - Pick-up  
3 - Forward  
2 - Conference  
13 - Autodial  
12 - Autodial  
11 - Autodial  
10 - Message  
Cancellation  
9 - Message  
Indication  
1 - DN  
0 - DN  
8 - Transfer  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
332  
Page 315 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed  
data  
General information  
The preprogrammed data on the Option 11C Mini system can provide a  
starting point for programming the system’s telephone and trunking  
information.  
This chapter shows how to change the Option 11C Mini default numbering  
plan. You can change the numbering plan for one or more of the following  
reasons:  
to change the first number in the numbering plan  
to shift the start of the numbering plan to another card slot  
the default numbering plan conflicts with the system data  
This section describes how to make changes to the default numbering plan.  
This section also provides information about modifying model telephone and  
trunk programming stored in the Option 11C Mini preprogrammed data.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Page 316 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Changing the default numbering plan  
Extensions assigned are different from the default numbering  
plan  
Compare the first digits assigned to this system with the default numbering  
plan.  
in the default numbering plan. To make this change, follow the  
instructions in “Changing the first number in the numbering plan” on  
page 316.  
If Meridian Mail Mini, trunk routes, or other data are using the first digit,  
you must remove the conflicting data. Follow the instructions found in  
“Removing numbering plan conflicts” on page 320.  
Changing the first number in the numbering plan  
To change the first number in the numbering plan perform the following  
procedure:  
Procedure 44  
Changing the first number in the numbering plan  
1
2
3
4
Lift the handset of the administration telephone.  
Enter the administration Flexible Feature Code.  
Enter the administration telephone password.  
You hear special dial tone and the prompt “TASK?” appears on the top  
line of the character display.  
5
Press the asterisk (*) three times.  
The second line of the character display reads “4 INSTALLATION  
OPTIONS'”.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 317 of 332  
6
Select “4 INSTALLATION OPTIONS” by entering the number “4”.  
The character display reads:  
1 DEFAULT SETS  
2 NUMBERING PLAN  
7
8
Select “2 NUMBERING PLAN” by entering the number “2”.  
The character display reads:  
FIRST NUMBER (XXXX)?  
To create a new first number, enter the digits you want and press  
the pound key.  
The first number you enter in the numbering plan is assigned to slot 1,  
unit zero of the Main Chassis. The default numbers assigned to the  
remaining card and unit combinations are in sequence, assuming each  
slot has up to 16 units.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Determining new extension numbers  
Perform the following procedure to change the default numbering plan, and  
to determine the extension number to assign to a specific telephone:  
Procedure 45  
Determine the extension number  
1
Identify the line card to which the telephone is connected. Take the  
card slot number associated with the card and subtract 1.  
2
3
4
Multiply this number by 16.  
Add the first extension number in the new numbering plan.  
Identify the unit number the telephone terminates on, and add it to the  
result from step 3.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 318 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Example:  
In this example, the new numbering plan starts at extension number 4500.  
You want to know the extension number of the telephone connected to card  
8, unit 12:  
1
2
Subtract 1 from the card slot number (8-1):  
Multiply by 16:  
= 7  
x 16  
=112  
3
4
Add the first extension number:+4500  
Add the unit number:+ 12  
Number assigned to card 8, unit 12 4624  
Note: If you are using a three digit numbering plan, follow the same  
procedure.  
Example:  
The new three digit numbering plan starts at extension number 300. You want  
to know the extension number of the telephone connected to card 8 unit 12:  
1
2
Subtract 1 from the card slot number (8-1):  
Multiply by 16:  
= 7  
x 16  
=112  
3
4
Add the first extension number:  
+ 300  
Add the unit number:  
+
12  
Number assigned to card 8, unit 12 424  
For the system to have a consecutive numbering plan, make sure that the line  
cards are in consecutive card slots in the Option 11C Mini chassis.  
If you arrange the line cards consecutively, the preassigned telephone  
extensions automatically configure during telephone activation. You do not  
have to manually enter the extensions.  
Using the Meridian Mail Mini Auto-configure feature  
The Meridian Mail Mini Auto-configure feature automatically matches  
Meridian Mail Mini mailboxes with telephone extensions. If you have the  
Meridian Mail Mini card option and you want to use the Meridian Mail Mini  
Auto-configure feature, make sure  
The numbering plan is consecutive.  
The first number in the Option 11 system and the Meridian Mail Mini  
system are the same.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 319 of 332  
Shifting the numbering plan to a new card slot  
The first number in the numbering plan is assigned to slot 1, unit 0. You can  
shift the first number in the numbering plan to a different card slot.  
The following procedure describes how to shift the first number in the  
numbering plan to a specific card slot.  
Procedure 46  
Shift the first number in the numbering plan to a different card slot  
1
Locate the first line card. Subtract 1 from the number of the card slot  
that it is in.  
2
3
Multiply this number by 16.  
Take the first number in the numbering plan and subtract the result  
from step 2.  
Note: When you enter the value from step 3 in response to the prompt  
“FIRST NUMBER (XXXX)?” on the administration telephone menu,  
the number shifts to the appropriate slot.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 320 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Example:  
The first number in the numbering plan is 2200. For the first number in the  
numbering plan to be 2300, and the first line card is in slot 6, perform the  
following calculation:  
1
Locate the first line card. Subtract 1 from the number of the card slot that  
it is in.  
6 - 1 = 5  
2
3
4
Multiply the number from step 1 by 16:  
5 X 16 = 80  
Subtract this number from the first number in the numbering plan:  
2300 - 80 = 2220  
Enter this value in response to the “FIRST NUMBER (2200)?” prompt  
on the administration telephone:  
FIRST NUMBER (2000)? 2220  
Removing numbering plan conflicts  
This section contains methods for removing any numbering plan conflicts  
that occur.  
Conflicts with Meridian Mail Mini data  
Manufacturers and distributors ship the Option 11C Mini system with data  
already programmed to support Meridian Mail Mini. The Meridian Mail Mini  
preprogrammed data can cause problems in the following situations:  
there is a numbering plan conflict with preprogrammed Meridian Mail  
Mini data and the programming required for another feature  
another circuit card requires card slot 10  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 321 of 332  
Obtaining the use of card slot 10  
If another circuit card requires card slot 10, remove the six Meridian Mail  
Mini agents programmed for this card slot. Load LD 11 on the TTY and  
respond to the system prompts, as shown below. Repeat the procedure for  
each of the six units that you want to remove.  
LD 11  
REQ  
OUT <CR>  
TYPE 2008 <CR>  
TN 10 XX <CR> “XX” = a value of 0,1,2,8,9, or 10  
Obtaining the use of Meridian Mail Mini ACD queues  
The Meridian Mail Mini feature also uses a number of ACD queues in the  
Option 11 system. See “Conflicts with ACD queues” on page 321 for  
information about how to remove this data from the system.  
Conflicts with ACD queues  
The Option 11C Mini has preprogrammed ACD queues for Meridian Mail  
Mini, the Central Answering Position, and general purpose ACD. To remove  
these values, use LD 23.  
Note: Before you remove this data from the system, make sure that all  
ACD agent information is removed from the queue.  
In LD 23, respond to the prompts as follows:  
LD 23  
REQ  
TYPE ACD  
CUST  
OUT  
0
ACDN XXXX “XXXX” = Value of ACD queue  
Repeat for each ACD queue you want to remove.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 322 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Conflicts with Call Park extension numbers  
Extension numbers for system call park are preprogrammed for the Central  
Answering Position. To remove this data from the system, load LD 50 and  
respond to the prompts as follows:  
LD 50  
REQ  
TYPE CPK  
CUST  
OUT  
0
SPDN XXXX “XXXX” = Value of Call Park extension  
Repeat for each Call Park extension you want to remove.  
Conflicts with SDI ports  
Five SDI/ESDI ports are preprogrammed on the Option 11C Mini system.  
Ports 8 and 9 are associated with the Meridian Mail Mini. Ports 0, 1 and 2 are  
associated with the NTDK97 MSC card. You cannot remove port 0; however,  
you can remove any of the remaining ports using LD 17 as follows:  
LD 17  
REQ  
CHG  
TYPE CFN  
ADAN OUT TTY X “X” = the TTY that you are removing.  
Conflicts with the SPRE code  
If the preprogrammed SPRE code conflicts with the programming required  
for the Option 11 system, use LD 15 to remove it. For customer 0 enter the  
following in response to the SPRE prompt:  
LD 15  
SPRE Xy “y” = the value of the SPRE code  
Note: To define a new SPRE code, type a space and enter the new  
number.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 323 of 332  
Conflicts with the attendant extension number  
You cannot remove the attendant extension number completely from the  
Option 11C Mini system data, but you can replace it with another number.  
LD 15  
REQ  
CHG  
CHG = Change  
TYPE CDB  
CDB = Customer Data Block  
CUST x “x” = Customer number  
.
ATDN xxxx “xxxx” = the new extension number  
Changing or removing the preprogrammed night number  
To change or remove the night number, use LD 15.  
LD 15  
REQ CHG CHG = Change  
TYPE CDB CDB = Customer Data Block  
CUST x “x” = Customer number  
NIT1  
bbbb, or X aaaa “bbbb” = the new extension number (DN)  
Or  
“aaaa” = the current night number  
(the night number is now removed).  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 324 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Conflicts with Flexible Feature Codes  
If the preprogrammed Flexible Feature Codes (FFC) conflict with the  
programming required for the Option 11C Mini system, remove the data from  
the system using LD 57.  
LD 57  
To change one or more access codes, enter the following commands:  
REQ  
CHG, END  
FFC  
Change or end  
TYPE  
CUST  
FFCT  
FFC = Flexible feature codes  
Customer Number  
0-31  
YES,(NO)  
FFC Confirmation tone  
Enter access code prompt (aaaa)  
CODE aaaa  
AAAA xx  
Enter the new access code prompt  
(AAAA)  
CODE <CR>  
Return to REQ  
End program  
REQ  
END  
To remove one access code, enter the following commands:  
REQ  
OUT  
FFC  
0-31  
Action request  
TYPE  
CUST  
FFC = Flexible feature codes  
Customer Number  
FFCT  
ALL  
YES,(NO)  
NO  
FFC Confirmation tone  
Remove specific access code  
Enter access code prompt (aaaa)  
CODE aaaa  
AAAA xx  
Enter the new access code prompt  
(AAAA)  
CODE <CR>  
Return to REQ  
End program  
REQ  
END  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 325 of 332  
To remove all access codes, enter the following commands:  
REQ  
OUT  
Action request  
TYPE FFC  
CUST 0-31  
FFCT YES,(NO)  
ALL YES  
FFC = Flexible feature codes  
Customer Number  
FFC Confirmation tone  
Remove all access codes  
Return to REQ  
CODE<CR>  
REQ END  
End program  
Creating, changing, and removing model telephones  
If you need a model telephone different from the default models provided in  
Option 11C Mini software, use overlays to design the models. Use the  
information in Table 104.  
Table 104  
Design model telephones  
Task  
Overlay  
Create model telephones:  
Analog telephones  
(500/2500 type telephones)  
LD 10  
LD 11  
Digital telephones  
Get information about model telephones  
LD 20  
(printout)  
If you require additional help when creating model telephones and  
trunks, refer to the Option 11C Software guides.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 326 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Creating analog telephone models  
You must enter the following information in LD 10 to create an analog  
(500/2500- type) telephone model:  
LD 10  
REQ NEW  
TYPE 500 M  
MODL YYY  
“YYY” = the model number of the  
telephone that you are creating  
Enter responses to the remaining prompts to complete the new model. (Refer  
to the Option 11 Software guides for a complete list of prompts and possible  
responses).  
Modifying analog model telephones  
If you want to modify an analog telephone, use LD 10 and enter the following  
commands on the TTY:  
LD 10  
REQ CHG  
TYPE 500 M  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number of the telephone that you are  
modifying  
For more information about LD 10, refer to the X11 Administration  
Input/Output Guide.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 327 of 332  
Creating digital model telephones  
To create model digital telephones, you must program key 0 with a function  
that can act as a prime extension number or its equivalent. This includes  
telephones that are programmed to have Single Call Ringing (SCR), Multiple  
Call Ringing (MCR), Single Call Non-Ringing (SCN), Multiple Call  
Non-Ringing (MCN), and Automatic Call Distribution (ACD).  
For ACD telephones, the model telephone defines the ACD queue. To define  
the extension number, you must enter the ID number of the agent or the  
Central Answering Position.  
You must enter the following information in LD 11 to create a digital  
telephone model:  
LD 11  
REQ NEW  
TYPE 2XXX M or 3000 M “XXX” = allowed telephone types  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number of the telephone that you are  
creating (between 1 - 127)  
Enter the responses to the remaining prompts to complete the new model.  
Refer to the Option 11C Software guides for a complete list of prompts and  
possible responses.  
Modifying digital model telephones  
If you want to modify a digital telephone, load LD 11 and enter the following  
commands on the TTY:  
LD 11  
REQ CHG  
TYPE 2XXX M or 3000 M “XXX” = allowed telephone types  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number of the telephone that you are  
modifying  
For more information about LD 11, refer to the X11 Administration  
Input/Output Guide.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 328 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Printing model information  
To print information about model telephones, use LD 20.  
Analog telephones  
LD 20  
REQ PRT  
TYPE 500 M  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the telephone model number.  
If you want to print all of the models for  
this telephone type, leave this value blank.  
Digital telephones  
Note: To print M3000 telephone models, you must enter “TYPE 3000  
M”. If you enter “TYPE 2XXX M”, you print all the Meridian Digital  
Telephone models except the M3000.  
LD 20  
REQ PRT  
TYPE 2XXX M or 3000 M “XXX” = the telephone type  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the telephone model number  
(between 1 - 127). If you want to print all  
of the models for this telephone type, leave  
this value blank.  
Removing model telephones  
Use LD 10 to remove analog telephone models and LD 11 to remove digital  
telephone models. Respond as follows to the prompts in either overlay:  
LD 10 or LD 11  
REQ  
OUT  
TYPE XXXX M “XXXX” = telephone type for the model  
you are removing (Example: 500, 2006,  
2317, 2216, 3000.)  
CUST  
0
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number associated  
with the telephone type you are removing  
(Valid range is 1-127).  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 329 of 332  
Creating model trunks and changing route access codes  
If you need a trunk that is different from the default models provided in  
Option 11C Mini software, use Overlay 14 to design a model. Change route  
access codes using the administration telephone.  
If you require additional help when creating model telephones and trunks,  
refer to the X11 Administration Input/Output Guide.  
Creating model trunks  
To create a new model trunk, load LD 14 and enter the following commands  
on the TTY:  
LD 14  
REQ NEW  
TYPE aaa M “aaa” = the type of trunk that you are  
creating (TIE, COT, WATS, and so on).  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number of the trunk that you are creating  
(between 1 - 127)  
XTRK XUT, XEM, XCOT, This prompt only appears when you  
XDID define the first model in a group. Each  
group contains 16 consecutive model  
definitions. (Refer to the group limits  
listed below.) When the first model in a  
group is defined, the remaining model  
numbers in the group(s) are taken to  
be of the same type.  
Group limits are as follows:  
1-15, 16-31, 32-47, 48-63, 64-79. 80-95, 96-111, 112-127.  
Examples:  
If, for example, you define a model trunk as XUT, with a model number of  
12, all models in the group 1-15 will automatically be XUT models. If you  
define another model trunk as an XEM, with a model number of 33, all  
models in the group 32-47 will automatically be XEM models.  
Note: When you create trunk models, you are not prompted for the trunk  
route or member number. This information is defined using the  
administration telephone to program the XUT or XEM circuit card.  
For more information about LD 14, refer to the X11 Administration  
Input/Output Guide.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Page 330 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
Modifying model trunks  
If you want to modify a trunk, load LD 14 and enter the following commands  
on the TTY:  
LD 14  
REQ CHG  
TYPE aaa M “aaa” = the type of trunk that you are  
modifying  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number of the trunk  
that you are modifying (between 1 - 127)  
Removing model trunks  
To remove a trunk model from the system, load LD 14 and respond to the  
prompts as follows:  
LD 14  
REQ  
OUT  
TYPE XXX M “XXX” = the trunk type of the model that  
you are removing (Examples: COT, TIE,  
DID, FEX, WAT, etc.)  
CUST  
0
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number associated  
with the trunk type you are removing  
(Valid range is 1-127).  
Printing model information  
To print information about model trunks, load LD 20 and enter the following  
commands on the TTY:  
LD 20  
REQ PRT  
TYPE TTTT M “TTTT” = the trunk type  
MODL YYY “YYY” = the model number. If you want to print all of the  
models for this trunk type, leave this value blank.  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data Page 331 of 332  
Changing a route access code  
Use this procedure to change a route access code.  
Procedure 47  
Changing a route access code  
1
2
Lift the handset of the administration telephone.  
Enter the administration Flexible Feature Code to access the  
administration menu.  
3
Enter the default password for the administration telephone.  
You hear special dial tone and the prompt  
“TASK?”  
appears on the top line of the character display. If you press the  
asterisk, “2 CHANGE ROUTE ACCESS” appears on the second line  
of the character display.  
4
5
Select “2 CHANGE ROUTE ACCESS” by entering the  
number “2”.  
The prompt  
“ROUTE ACCESS?”  
appears on the character display.  
Enter the access code of the route you want to modify, and press  
the pound key (#).  
The prompt  
“NEW ACCESS CODE?”  
asks you for a new access code for the route.  
Option 11C Mini Planning and Installation Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Page 332 of 332  
Appendix B – Changing preprogrammed data  
6
Enter the new access code and press the pound key.  
The display shows  
“CODE CHANGED”.  
After a delay of approximately four seconds, you hear special dial tone  
and the sequence repeats when the prompt  
“ROUTE ACCESS?”  
appears.  
OR  
If the route access code is not available for use, you hear overflow  
tone.  
The display shows  
“USED, ROUTE ACCESS?”  
and you must repeat this step.  
You must enter a different access code. This sequence continues  
until you enter an appropriate new access code.  
7
Terminate the sequence by hanging up the telephone.  
OR  
Repeat the sequence by going through the steps again.  
—————————— End of Procedure ——————————  
553-3021-209 Standard 3.00 April 2000  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Family Product Manual Contacts Copyright FCC notice Trademarks  
Document number Product release Document release Date Publish  
Meridian 1  
Option 11C Mini  
Planning and Installation Guide  
Copyright © 1999–2000 Nortel Networks  
All Rights Reserved  
Information is subject to change without notice. Nortel  
Networks reserves the right to make changes in  
design or components as progress in engineering and  
manufacturing may warrant. This equipment has been  
tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A  
digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules,  
and the radio interference regulations of Industry  
Canada. These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful interference  
when the equipment is operated in a commercial  
environment. This equipment generates, uses and can  
radiate radio frequency energy, and if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instruction manual, may  
cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is  
likely to cause harmful interference in which case the  
user will be required to correct the interference at their  
own expense.  
SL-1 and Meridian 1 are trademarks of Nortel  
Networks.  
Publication number: 553-3021-209  
Document release: Standard 3.00  
Date: April 2000  
Printed in Canada  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Clothes Dryer t 294 c User Manual
Miele Pet Care Product HS08 User Manual
Mountain Buggy Stroller Breeze Single B1204 User Manual
Napoleon Fireplaces Indoor Fireplace EF38H User Manual
NEC Switch N8191 09 User Manual
Nextar Computer Monitor MA809 User Manual
NordicTrack Treadmill NTL15920 User Manual
Omnimount TV Mount OM1004283 User Manual
Panasonic Air Conditioner CS KE18NB4UW User Manual
Panasonic Network Card MAZSxxxG Series User Manual